blob: f1afbc9a2b739b7f94da5bec767396749b90e574 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Olivier Houchard1fc05162017-04-06 01:05:05 +0200590 - no-unused-socket
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200591 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200592 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200593 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - tune.buffers.limit
595 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200596 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200597 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100598 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100599 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200600 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100601 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100603 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100604 - tune.lua.session-timeout
605 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200606 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100607 - tune.maxaccept
608 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200609 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200610 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200611 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100612 - tune.rcvbuf.client
613 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100614 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100615 - tune.sndbuf.client
616 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100617 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200619 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100620 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200621 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200622 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100623 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200624 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100625 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200626 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
627 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
628 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100629 - tune.zlib.memlevel
630 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100631
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200632 * Debugging
633 - debug
634 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200635
636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006373.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200638------------------------------------
639
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200640ca-base <dir>
641 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200642 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
643 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200644
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200645chroot <jail dir>
646 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
647 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
648 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
649 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
650 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
651 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100652
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100653cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
654 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
655 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
656 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100657 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
658 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
659 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
660 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
661 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
662 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
663 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
664 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
665 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
666 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100667
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200668crt-base <dir>
669 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
670 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
671 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
672
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673daemon
674 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
675 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
676 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
677
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200678deviceatlas-json-file <path>
679 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
680 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
681
682deviceatlas-log-level <value>
683 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
684 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
685
686deviceatlas-separator <char>
687 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
688 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
689
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100690deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200691 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
692 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
693 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100694
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900695external-check
696 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
697 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
698 See "option external-check".
699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200700gid <number>
701 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
702 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
703 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100704 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
705 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100707
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100708hard-stop-after <time>
709 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
710
711 Arguments :
712 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
713 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
714 SIGUSR1 signal.
715
716 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
717 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
718 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
719
720 Example:
721 global
722 hard-stop-after 30s
723
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200724group <group name>
725 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
726 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100727
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200728log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200729 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
730 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100731 configured with "log global".
732
733 <address> can be one of:
734
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100735 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100736 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
737 port).
738
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100739 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
740 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
741 port).
742
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100743 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
744 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
745 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
746 writeable).
747
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200748 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
749 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100750
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200751 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
752 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
753 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
754 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
755 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
756 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
757 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
758 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
759 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
760 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
761 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
762
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200763 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
764 one of the following :
765
766 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
767 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
768
769 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
771
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100772 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200773
774 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
775 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
776 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
777
778 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200779 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
780 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
781 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
782 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
783 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
784 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200785
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200786 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100788log-send-hostname [<string>]
789 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
790 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
791 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
792 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
793 the logs.
794
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000795log-tag <string>
796 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
797 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
798 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100799 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000800
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100801lua-load <file>
802 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
803 used multiple times.
804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805nbproc <number>
806 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
807 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
808 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
809 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
810 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
811
812pidfile <pidfile>
813 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
814 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
815 starting the process. See also "daemon".
816
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100817presetenv <name> <value>
818 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
819 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
820 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
821 and "unsetenv".
822
823resetenv [<name> ...]
824 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
825 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
826 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
827 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
828 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
829 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
830 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
831 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
832
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100833stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200834 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
835 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
836 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
837 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
838 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
839 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100840 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200841 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
842 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200843
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200844server-state-base <directory>
845 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200846 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
847 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200848
849server-state-file <file>
850 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
851 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
852 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
853 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
854 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
855 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
856 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
857 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200858 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
859 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200860
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100861setenv <name> <value>
862 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
863 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
864 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
865 and "unsetenv".
866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100867ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
869 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300870 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100871 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
872 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
873 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
874 "bind" keyword for more information.
875
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100876ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
878 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
879 keyword to see available options.
880
881 Example:
882 global
883 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
884
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100885ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
886 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
887 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300888 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100889 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
890 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
891 information.
892
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100893ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
895 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
896 keyword to see available options.
897
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200898ssl-dh-param-file <file>
899 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
900 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
901 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
902 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
903 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200904 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
905 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
906 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
907 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200908 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
909 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
910 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
911
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100912ssl-server-verify [none|required]
913 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
914 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
915 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
916
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200917stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
918 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
919 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
920 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200921 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
922 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200923
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200924 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
925 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
926 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200927
928stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
929 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
930 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100931 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932
933stats maxconn <connections>
934 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
935 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200937uid <number>
938 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
939 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
940 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
941 one. See also "gid" and "user".
942
943ulimit-n <number>
944 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
945 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
946 option.
947
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100948unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
949 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
950
951 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
952 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
953 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
954 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
955 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
956 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
957 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
958 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
959 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
960 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
961
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100962unsetenv [<name> ...]
963 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
964 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
965 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
966 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
967 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
968 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
969 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
970
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200971user <user name>
972 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
973 See also "uid" and "group".
974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200975node <name>
976 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
977
978 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
979 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
980 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
981 traffic.
982
983description <text>
984 Add a text that describes the instance.
985
986 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
987 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
988 "<" and ">" characters.
989
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010099051degrees-data-file <file path>
991 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
992 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
993
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200994 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100995 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
996
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100998 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
999 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1000 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1001
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001002 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001003 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1004
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001006 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1007 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1008
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001009 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1010 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1011
101251degrees-cache-size <number>
1013 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1014 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1015 By default, this cache is disabled.
1016
1017 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001018 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1019
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001020wurfl-data-file <file path>
1021 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1022 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1023
1024 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1025 with USE_WURFL=1.
1026
1027wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1028 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1029 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1030 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1031
1032 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1033
1034 Valid WURFL properties are:
1035 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1036
1037 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1038 device.
1039
1040 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1041 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1042
1043 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1044 particular web request.
1045
1046 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1047 used Libwurfl API version.
1048
1049 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1050 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1051 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1052
1053 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1054 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1055
1056 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1057 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1058
1059 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1060
1061 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1062
1063 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1064 with USE_WURFL=1.
1065
1066wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1067 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1068 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1069
1070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1071 with USE_WURFL=1.
1072
1073wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1074 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1075 thus before the chroot.
1076
1077 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1078 with USE_WURFL=1.
1079
1080wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1081 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1082 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1083 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1084 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1085 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1086 mode is enabled by default.
1087
1088 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1089 with USE_WURFL=1.
1090
1091wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1092 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1093 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1094 - "0" : no cache is used.
1095 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1096 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1097 the highest performing option.
1098
1099 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1100 with USE_WURFL=1.
1101
1102wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1103 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1104 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1105
1106 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1107 with USE_WURFL=1.
1108
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111-----------------------
1112
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001113max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1114 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1115 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1116 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1117 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1118 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1119 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1120 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1121 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001123maxconn <number>
1124 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1125 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1126 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001127 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1128 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1129 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1130 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001131 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1132 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1133 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1134 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1135 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001137maxconnrate <number>
1138 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1139 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1140 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1141 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1142 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1143 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1144 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1145 fairness.
1146
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001147maxcomprate <number>
1148 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001149 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001150 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1151 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1152 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1153 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1154 default value.
1155
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001156maxcompcpuusage <number>
1157 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1158 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1159 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1160 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1161 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1162 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1163 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1164 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1165
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001166maxpipes <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1168 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1169 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1170 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1171 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1172 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1173
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001174maxsessrate <number>
1175 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1176 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1177 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1178 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1179 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1180 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1181 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1182 fairness.
1183
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001184maxsslconn <number>
1185 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1186 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1187 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1188 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1189 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1190 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1191 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001192 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1193 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1194 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1195 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1196 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1197 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1198 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001199
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001200maxsslrate <number>
1201 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1202 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1203 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1204 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1205 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1206 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1207 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1208 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1209 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1210 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1211
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001212maxzlibmem <number>
1213 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1214 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1215 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001216 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1217 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1218 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1219
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001220noepoll
1221 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1222 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001223 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001224
1225nokqueue
1226 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1227 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1228 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1229
1230nopoll
1231 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1232 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001234 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001235
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001236nosplice
1237 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1238 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1239 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001240 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001241 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1242 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1243 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1244 "option splice-response".
1245
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001246nogetaddrinfo
1247 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1248 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1249
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001250noreuseport
1251 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1252 command line argument "-dR".
1253
Olivier Houchard1fc05162017-04-06 01:05:05 +02001254no-unused-socket
1255 By default, each haproxy process keeps all sockets opened, event those that
1256 are only used by another processes, so that any process can provide all the
1257 sockets, to make reloads seamless. This option disables this, and close all
1258 unused sockets, to save some file descriptors.
1259
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001261 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1262 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1263 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1264 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1265 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1266 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001267
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001268tune.buffers.limit <number>
1269 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1270 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1271 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1272 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1273 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1274 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1275 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1276 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1277 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1278 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1279 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1280 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1281 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1282 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1283 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1284
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001285tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1286 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1287 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1288 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1289 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1290
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001291tune.bufsize <number>
1292 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1293 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1294 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1295 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1296 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1297 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1298 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1299 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001300 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1301 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1302 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001303
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001304tune.chksize <number>
1305 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1306 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1307 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1308 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1309 checks whenever possible.
1310
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001311tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1312 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1313 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1314 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1315 this value. The default value is 1.
1316
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001317tune.http.cookielen <number>
1318 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1319 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1320 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1321 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1322 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1323 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1324 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1325 to change this value.
1326
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001327tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1328 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1329 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1330 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1331 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1332 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1333 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1334 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1335 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1336 limit too high.
1337
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001338tune.idletimer <timeout>
1339 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1340 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1341 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1342 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1343 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1344 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1345 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1346 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1347 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1348
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001349tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1350 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001351 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001352 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1353 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1354 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1355 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1356 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1357
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001358tune.lua.maxmem
1359 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1360 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1361 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1362 memory.
1363
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001364tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1365 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001366 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1367 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1368 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001369
1370tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1371 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1372 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1373 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1374 check servers.
1375
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001376tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1377 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1378 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1379 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1380 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1381
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001382tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001383 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1384 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1385 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1386 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1387 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1388 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1389 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1390 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1391 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1392 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001393
1394tune.maxpollevents <number>
1395 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1396 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1397 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1398 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1399 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1400
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001401tune.maxrewrite <number>
1402 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1403 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1404 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1405 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1406 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1407 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1408 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1409 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1410 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1411 bufsize.
1412
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001413tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1414 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1415 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1416 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1417 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1418 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1419 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1420 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1421 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1422 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1423 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1424 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1425 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1426 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1427 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1428 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1429 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1430 setting this parameter to 0.
1431
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001432tune.pipesize <number>
1433 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1434 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1435 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1436 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1437 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1438 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1439
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001440tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1441tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1442 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1443 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1444 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1445 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1446 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1447 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1448 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1449
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001450tune.recv_enough <number>
1451 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1452 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1453 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1454 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1455 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1456
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001457tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1458tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1459 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1460 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1461 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1462 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1463 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1464 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1465 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1466 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1467 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1468 notifying haproxy again.
1469
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001470tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001471 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1472 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1473 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001474 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001475 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1476 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1477 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1478 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1479 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001480 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1481 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001482
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001483tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1484 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1485 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1486 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1487 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1488 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1489 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1490
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001491tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1492 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001493 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001494 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1495 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1496 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1497 being used for too long.
1498
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001499tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1500 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1501 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1502 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1503 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1504 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1505 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1506 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1507 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1508 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1509 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001510 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1511 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001512
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001513tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1514 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1515 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1516 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1517 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1518 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1519 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1520 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001521 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1522 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001523
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001524tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1525 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1526 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1527 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1528 1000 entries.
1529
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001530tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1531 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1532 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1533 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1534
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001535tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001536tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001537tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1538tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1539tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001540 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1541 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1542 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1543 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1544 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1545 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1546 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1547 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001548
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001549 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1550 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1551 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1552 all available space is consumed.
1553 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1554 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1555 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001556
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001557tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1558 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001559 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001560 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1561 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1562 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1563
1564tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1565 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1566 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1567 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1568 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001569
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015703.3. Debugging
1571--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001572
1573debug
1574 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1575 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1576 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1577 system startup.
1578
1579quiet
1580 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1581 line argument "-q".
1582
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015843.4. Userlists
1585--------------
1586It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1587http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1588it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1589
1590userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001591 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001592 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1593
1594group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001595 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001596 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1597 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1598
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001599user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1600 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001601 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1602 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001603 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1604 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001605 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001606 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001607
1608
1609 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001610 userlist L1
1611 group G1 users tiger,scott
1612 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001613
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001614 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1615 user scott insecure-password elgato
1616 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001617
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001618 userlist L2
1619 group G1
1620 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001621
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001622 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1623 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1624 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001625
1626 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001627
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001628
16293.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001630----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001631It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1632several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1633instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1634values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1635automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1636In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1637using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1638tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1639reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1640Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1641that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1642each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001643
1644peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001645 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001646 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1647
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001648disabled
1649 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1650 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1651 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1652
1653enable
1654 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1655
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1657 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1658 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1659 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1660 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1661 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1662 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1663
1664 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1665 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1666
1667 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1668 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1669 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1670 across all peers.
1671
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001672 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1673 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001674
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001675 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001676 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001677 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1678 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1679 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001680
1681 backend mybackend
1682 mode tcp
1683 balance roundrobin
1684 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1685 stick on src
1686
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001687 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1688 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001689
1690
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016913.6. Mailers
1692------------
1693It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1694If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1695in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1696
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001697mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001698 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1699 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1700
1701mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1702 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1703
1704 Example:
1705 mailers mymailers
1706 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1707 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1708
1709 backend mybackend
1710 mode tcp
1711 balance roundrobin
1712
1713 email-alert mailers mymailers
1714 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1715 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1716
1717 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1718 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1719
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001720timeout mail <time>
1721 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1722 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1723 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1724 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1725
1726 Example:
1727 mailers mymailers
1728 timeout mail 20s
1729 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001730
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017314. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001732----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001733
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001734Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001735 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001736 - frontend <name>
1737 - backend <name>
1738 - listen <name>
1739
1740A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1741its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1742section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
1745A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1746connections.
1747
1748A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1749to forward incoming connections.
1750
1751A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1752parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1753
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001754All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1755'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1756case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1757
1758Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1759logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1760proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1761However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1762name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1763
1764Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1765and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001766bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001767protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1768modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1769arbitrary criteria.
1770
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001771In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1772a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1773the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1774
1775 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1776 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1777 between responses and new requests.
1778
1779 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1780 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1781 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1782 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1783
1784 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1785 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1786 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1787
1788 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1789 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1790 client-facing connection remains open.
1791
1792 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1793 after the end of the response.
1794
1795The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1796frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1797following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1798weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1799
1800 Backend mode
1801
1802 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1803 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1804 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1805 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1806 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1807 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1808 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1809 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1810 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1811 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1812 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1813
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001814
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018164.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1817--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001819The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1820limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1821they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1822limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001824option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001825and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1826with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1827specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001828
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001829
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001830 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1831------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1832acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001833appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001834backlog X X X -
1835balance X - X X
1836bind - X X -
1837bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001838block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001839capture cookie - X X -
1840capture request header - X X -
1841capture response header - X X -
1842clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001843compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001844contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1845cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001846declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847default-server X - X X
1848default_backend X X X -
1849description - X X X
1850disabled X X X X
1851dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001852email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001853email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001854email-alert mailers X X X X
1855email-alert myhostname X X X X
1856email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857enabled X X X X
1858errorfile X X X X
1859errorloc X X X X
1860errorloc302 X X X X
1861-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1862errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001863force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001864filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001865fullconn X - X X
1866grace X X X X
1867hash-type X - X X
1868http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001869http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001870http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001871http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001872http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001873http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001874http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001876ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001877load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001878log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001879log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001880log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001881log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001882max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883maxconn X X X -
1884mode X X X X
1885monitor fail - X X -
1886monitor-net X X X -
1887monitor-uri X X X -
1888option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1889option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1890option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1891option allbackups (*) X - X X
1892option checkcache (*) X - X X
1893option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1894option contstats (*) X X X -
1895option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1896option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1897option forceclose (*) X X X X
1898-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1899option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001900option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001901option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001902option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001903option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001904option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001905option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001906option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001907option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1908option httpchk X - X X
1909option httpclose (*) X X X X
1910option httplog X X X X
1911option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001912option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001913option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001914option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001915option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1916option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1917option logasap (*) X X X -
1918option mysql-check X - X X
1919option nolinger (*) X X X X
1920option originalto X X X X
1921option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001922option pgsql-check X - X X
1923option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001924option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001925option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001926option smtpchk X - X X
1927option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1928option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1929option splice-request (*) X X X X
1930option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001931option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001932option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1933option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1934-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001935option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1937option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1938option tcpka X X X X
1939option tcplog X X X X
1940option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001941external-check command X - X X
1942external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001943persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1944rate-limit sessions X X X -
1945redirect - X X X
1946redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1947redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1948reqadd - X X X
1949reqallow - X X X
1950reqdel - X X X
1951reqdeny - X X X
1952reqiallow - X X X
1953reqidel - X X X
1954reqideny - X X X
1955reqipass - X X X
1956reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001957reqitarpit - X X X
1958reqpass - X X X
1959reqrep - X X X
1960-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001961reqtarpit - X X X
1962retries X - X X
1963rspadd - X X X
1964rspdel - X X X
1965rspdeny - X X X
1966rspidel - X X X
1967rspideny - X X X
1968rspirep - X X X
1969rsprep - X X X
1970server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001971server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02001972server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001973source X - X X
1974srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001975stats admin - X X X
1976stats auth X X X X
1977stats enable X X X X
1978stats hide-version X X X X
1979stats http-request - X X X
1980stats realm X X X X
1981stats refresh X X X X
1982stats scope X X X X
1983stats show-desc X X X X
1984stats show-legends X X X X
1985stats show-node X X X X
1986stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001987-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1988stick match - - X X
1989stick on - - X X
1990stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001991stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01001992stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001993tcp-check connect - - X X
1994tcp-check expect - - X X
1995tcp-check send - - X X
1996tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001997tcp-request connection - X X -
1998tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001999tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002000tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002001tcp-response content - - X X
2002tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002003timeout check X - X X
2004timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002005timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002006timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2007timeout connect X - X X
2008timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2009timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2010timeout http-request X X X X
2011timeout queue X - X X
2012timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002013timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2015timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002016timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002017transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002018unique-id-format X X X -
2019unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002020use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002021use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2023 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002024
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020264.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2027---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002028
2029This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2030
2031
2032acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2033 Declare or complete an access list.
2034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2035 no | yes | yes | yes
2036 Example:
2037 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2038 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2039 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002041 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042
2043
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002044appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2045 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2048 no | no | yes | yes
2049 Arguments :
2050 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2051 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2052
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002053 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054 checked in each cookie value.
2055
2056 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2057 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2058 milliseconds.
2059
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002060 request-learn
2061 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2062 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2063 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2064 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2065 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2066 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2067
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002068 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2069 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2070 data following this prefix.
2071
2072 Example :
2073 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2074
2075 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2076 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2077
2078 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2079 2 modes are currently supported :
2080 - path-parameters :
2081 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2082 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2083 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2084 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2085 - query-string :
2086 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2087 query string.
2088
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002089 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2090 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2091 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002092
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002093 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2094 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002095
2096
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002097backlog <conns>
2098 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2100 yes | yes | yes | no
2101 Arguments :
2102 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2103 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002104 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002105
2106 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2107 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2108 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2109 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2110 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2111 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2112 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2113 backlog parameter.
2114
2115 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2116 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2117 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2118
2119 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2120
2121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002123balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2126 yes | no | yes | yes
2127 Arguments :
2128 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2129 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2130 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2131 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2132
2133 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2134 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2135 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2136 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002137 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002138 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002139 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2140 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2141 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2142 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2143 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2144 it, so that you don't worry.
2145
2146 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2147 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2148 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2149 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2150 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2151 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2152 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2153 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002154
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002155 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2156 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2157 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2158 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2159 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2160 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2161 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2162 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2163
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002164 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002165 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002166 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2167 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002168 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002169 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2170 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2171 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2172 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2173 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002174 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2175 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2176 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2177 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2178 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2179 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002180
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2182 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2183 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2184 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2185 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2186 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2187 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2188 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002189 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002190 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002191 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2192 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2193 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002194
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002195 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2196 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2197 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2198 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2199 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2200 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2201 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2202 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2203 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2204 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2205 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2206 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002207
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002208 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002209 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2210 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2211 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2212 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2213 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2214 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2215 URIs start with a leading "/".
2216
2217 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2218 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2219 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2220 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2221
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002222 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002223 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2224
2225 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002226 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2227 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002228 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2229 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2230 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2231 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002232 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002233 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2234 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002235
2236 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2237 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2238 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2239 server will receive the request.
2240
2241 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2242 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2243 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2244 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2245 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002246 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2247 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2248 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002249
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002250 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2251 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2252 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2253 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2254 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002256 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002257 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2258 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2259 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2260
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002261 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2262 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2263 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2264
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002265 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002266 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002267 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2268 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2269 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2270 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2271 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2272 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002273 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002274 used instead.
2275
2276 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2277 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2278 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2279 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2280
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002281 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2282 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2283 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2284
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002285 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002286
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002287 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002288 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2289 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002290
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002291 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2292 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2293 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002294
2295 Examples :
2296 balance roundrobin
2297 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002298 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002299 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2300 balance hdr(host)
2301 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002302
2303 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2304 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2305
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002306 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002307 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2308 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2309 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2310 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2311
2312 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2313 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2314 defaults to 16 kB.
2315
2316 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2317 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2318
2319 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2320 Round Robin.
2321
2322 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2323 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2324 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2325 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2326
2327 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2328
2329 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002330 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002331 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2332 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2333 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002334
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002335 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336
2337
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002338bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2339bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2342 no | yes | yes | no
2343 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002344 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2345 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2346 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2347 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002348 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002349 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2350 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2351 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2352 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2353 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2354 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2355 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002356 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2357 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2358 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2359 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2360 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2361 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2362 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002363 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2364 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2365 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002366 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2367 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2368 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002369
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002370 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2371 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002372 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2373 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2374 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002375 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2376 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2377 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2378 the range.
2379
2380 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2381 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2382 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2383 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2384 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2385 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2386 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002387 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002388 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002389
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002390 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2391 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2392 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2393 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2394 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2395 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2396 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2397 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002399 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2400 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2401 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2402 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002404 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2405 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2406 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2407 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2408 in a frontend.
2409
2410 Example :
2411 listen http_proxy
2412 bind :80,:443
2413 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002414 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002415
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002416 listen http_https_proxy
2417 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002418 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002419
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002420 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2421 bind ipv6@:80
2422 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2423 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2424
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002425 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002426 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002427
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002428 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2429 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2430 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2431 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2432 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2433
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002434 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002435 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436
2437
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002438bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002439 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2441 yes | yes | yes | yes
2442 Arguments :
2443 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2444 may be used to override a default value.
2445
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002446 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002447 option may be combined with other numbers.
2448
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002449 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002450 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2451 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2452 missing from all processes.
2453
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002454 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002455 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002456 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2457 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2458 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2459 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002460
2461 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2462 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2463 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2464 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2465 and 'even' instances.
2466
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002467 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2468 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2469 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2470 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002471
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002472 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2473 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2474
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002475 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2476 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2477 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2478
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002479 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2480 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2481
2482 Example :
2483 listen app_ip1
2484 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002485 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486
2487 listen app_ip2
2488 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002489 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002490
2491 listen management
2492 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002493 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002494
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002495 listen management
2496 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2497 bind-process 1-4
2498
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002499 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002500
2501
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002502block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2505 no | yes | yes | yes
2506
2507 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2508 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002509 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002510 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002512 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2513 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2514 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002516 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2517 "http-request deny" instead.
2518
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519 Example:
2520 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2521 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2522 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002523 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2524 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2525 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002526
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002527 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2528 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2529 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002530
2531capture cookie <name> len <length>
2532 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 no | yes | yes | no
2535 Arguments :
2536 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2537 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2538 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2539 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2540 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2541
2542 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2543 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2544 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2545 right if it exceeds <length>.
2546
2547 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2548 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2549 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2550 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2551
2552 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2553 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2554 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2555
2556 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2557 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2558 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002559 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2560 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2561 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002562
2563 Example:
2564 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2565
2566 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002567 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568
2569
2570capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002571 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2573 no | yes | yes | no
2574 Arguments :
2575 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002576 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2578 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2579 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2580
2581 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2582 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2583 it exceeds <length>.
2584
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002585 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2587 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002588 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2589 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2590 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2591 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002592 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002593 environments to find where the request came from.
2594
2595 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2596 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2597 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2598 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002600 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2601 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2602 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2603 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2604 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605
2606 Example:
2607 capture request header Host len 15
2608 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002609 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002611 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002612 about logging.
2613
2614
2615capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002616 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002617 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2618 no | yes | yes | no
2619 Arguments :
2620 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002621 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002622 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2623 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2624 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2625
2626 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2627 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2628 it exceeds <length>.
2629
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002630 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2632 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2633 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002634 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2635 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2636 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2637 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002639 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2640 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2641 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2642 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2643 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002644
2645 Example:
2646 capture response header Content-length len 9
2647 capture response header Location len 15
2648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002649 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002650 about logging.
2651
2652
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002653clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002654 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 yes | yes | yes | no
2657 Arguments :
2658 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2659 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2660 as explained at the top of this document.
2661
2662 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2663 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2664 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2665 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2666 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2667 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2668 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2669 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002670 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002671 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2672 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2673
2674 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2675 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2676 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2677 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2678 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2679 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2680
2681 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2682 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2683
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002684 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2685 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002686
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002687compression algo <algorithm> ...
2688compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002689compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002690 Enable HTTP compression.
2691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2692 yes | yes | yes | yes
2693 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002694 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2695 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2696 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2697
2698 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002699 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2700 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2701 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002702
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002703 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002704 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002705
2706 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2707 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2708 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2709 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2710 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002711 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002712
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002713 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2714 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2715 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2716 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2717 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2718 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2719 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002720 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002721
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002722 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002723 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002724 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2725 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2726 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2727 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2728 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002729
2730 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2731 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2732 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2733 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2734 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002735 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2736 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2737 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2738 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2739 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002740 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2741 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002742
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002743 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002744 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2745 "Accept-Encoding" header
2746 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002747 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002748 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2749 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002750 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2751 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2752 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2753 "multipart"
2754 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2755 header
2756 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2757 and later
2758 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2759 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002760
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002761 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2762 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002763
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002764 Examples :
2765 compression algo gzip
2766 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002767
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002768
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002769contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2772 yes | no | yes | yes
2773 Arguments :
2774 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2776 as explained at the top of this document.
2777
2778 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002779 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002780 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002781 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2782 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2783 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2784 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2785
2786 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2787 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2788 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2789 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2790 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2791 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2792
2793 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2794 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2795 instead.
2796
2797 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2798 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2799
2800
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002801cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002802 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2803 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002804 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002805 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2807 yes | no | yes | yes
2808 Arguments :
2809 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2810 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2811 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2812 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2813 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2814 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2815 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2816 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2817 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2818
2819 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2820 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2821 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2822 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2823 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2824 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002825 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2826 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2827 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2828 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2829 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002830
2831 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002832 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002833
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002834 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002835 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2836 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2837 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2838 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2839 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2840 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2841 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2842 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2843 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2844 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
2846 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2847 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2848 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2849 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2850 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2851 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2852 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2853 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2854 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002855 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002856 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2857 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2858 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002860 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2861 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2862 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002863 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2864 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2865 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2866 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002867 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2868 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2869 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870
2871 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2872 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2873 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2874 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2875 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2876 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2877 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2878 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2879 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2880
2881 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2882 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2883 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2884 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2885 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2886 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2887 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2888 persistence cookie in the cache.
2889 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2890
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002891 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2892 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2893 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2894 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2895 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2896 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2897 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2898 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2899 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2900 they logout.
2901
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002902 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2903 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2904 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2905 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2906
2907 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2908 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2909 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2910 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2911 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2912 this attribute.
2913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002914 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002915 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002916 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2917 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2918 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2919 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2920 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2921 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002922
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002923 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2924 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2925 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2926 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2927 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2928 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2929 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2930 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2931 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2932 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2933 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2934 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2935 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2936 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2937 the site.
2938
2939 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2940 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2941 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2942 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2943 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2944 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2945 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2946 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2947 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2948 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2949 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2950 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2951 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2952 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2953 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2954 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2955
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002956 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2957 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2958 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2959 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2960 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2961 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2962
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2964 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2965 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2966 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002967
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968 Examples :
2969 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2970 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2971 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002972 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002973
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002974 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002976
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002977declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2978 Declares a capture slot.
2979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 no | yes | yes | no
2981 Arguments:
2982 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2983
2984 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2985 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2986 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2987 for use in the response.
2988
2989 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002990 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002991 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2992
2993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002994default-server [param*]
2995 Change default options for a server in a backend
2996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2997 yes | no | yes | yes
2998 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002999 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3000 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3001 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3002 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003003
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003004 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003005 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3006
3007 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003008
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003009
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003010default_backend <backend>
3011 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3013 yes | yes | yes | no
3014 Arguments :
3015 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3016
3017 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3018 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3019 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3020 will catch all undetermined requests.
3021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022 Example :
3023
3024 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3025 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3026 default_backend dynamic
3027
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003028 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003031description <string>
3032 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3034 no | yes | yes | yes
3035 Arguments : string
3036
3037 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3038 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3039 it describes.
3040 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3041
3042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003043disabled
3044 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3046 yes | yes | yes | yes
3047 Arguments : none
3048
3049 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3050 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3051 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3052 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3053 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3054 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3055 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3056
3057 See also : "enabled"
3058
3059
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003060dispatch <address>:<port>
3061 Set a default server address
3062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3063 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003064 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003065
3066 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3067 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3068 during start-up.
3069
3070 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3071 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3072 possible with normal servers.
3073
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003074 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003075 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3076 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3077 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3078 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3079
3080 See also : "server"
3081
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003082
3083dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3084 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 yes | no | yes | yes
3087 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3088
3089 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3090 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3091 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3092 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3093 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3094 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003095
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003096enabled
3097 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3099 yes | yes | yes | yes
3100 Arguments : none
3101
3102 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3103 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3104
3105 See also : "disabled"
3106
3107
3108errorfile <code> <file>
3109 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 yes | yes | yes | yes
3112 Arguments :
3113 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003114 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3115 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116
3117 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003118 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003119 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003120 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3121 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122
3123 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3124 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3125 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3126
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003127 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003129 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3130 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3131 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3132 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3133
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003134 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3135 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3136 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3137 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3138 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3139 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003141 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3142 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3143 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003144 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3146
3147 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3148
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003149 Example :
3150 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003151 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003152 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3153 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3154
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003155
3156errorloc <code> <url>
3157errorloc302 <code> <url>
3158 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3160 yes | yes | yes | yes
3161 Arguments :
3162 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003163 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3164 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003165
3166 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3167 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3168 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3169 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3170 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3171
3172 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3173 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3174 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3175
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003176 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3177
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003178 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3179 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3180 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3181 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003182 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003183 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3184 request.
3185
3186 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3187
3188
3189errorloc303 <code> <url>
3190 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3192 yes | yes | yes | yes
3193 Arguments :
3194 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003195 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3196 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003197
3198 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3199 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3200 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3201 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3202 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3203
3204 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3205 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3206 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3207
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003208 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3209
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003210 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3211 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3212 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3213 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003214 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003215
3216 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3217
3218
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003219email-alert from <emailaddr>
3220 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3221 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3222 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3223 yes | yes | yes | yes
3224
3225 Arguments :
3226
3227 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3228
3229 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3230 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3231
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003232 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003233 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3234 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003235
3236
3237email-alert level <level>
3238 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3239 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3240 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3241 yes | yes | yes | yes
3242
3243 Arguments :
3244
3245 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3246 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3247 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3248
3249 By default level is alert
3250
3251 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3252 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3253 for the proxy.
3254
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003255 Alerts are sent when :
3256
3257 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3258 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3259 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3260 is notice or lower
3261 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3262 and a health check status update occurs
3263
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003264 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3265 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003266 section 3.6 about mailers.
3267
3268
3269email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3270 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3272 yes | yes | yes | yes
3273
3274 Arguments :
3275
3276 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3277
3278 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3279 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3280
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003281 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3282 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003283
3284
3285email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3286 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3287 mailers.
3288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3289 yes | yes | yes | yes
3290
3291 Arguments :
3292
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003293 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003294
3295 By default the systems hostname is used.
3296
3297 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3298 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3299 for the proxy.
3300
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003301 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3302 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003303
3304
3305email-alert to <emailaddr>
3306 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3307 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3308 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3309 yes | yes | yes | yes
3310
3311 Arguments :
3312
3313 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3314
3315 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3316 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3317
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003318 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003319 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3320
3321
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003322force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3323 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3325 no | yes | yes | yes
3326
3327 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3328 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3329 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3330 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3331 marked down for maintenance operations.
3332
3333 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3334 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3335 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3336 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3337 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3338 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3339 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3340 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3341 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3342
3343 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3344 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3345 is used.
3346
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003347 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003348 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003349
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003350
3351filter <name> [param*]
3352 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 no | yes | yes | yes
3355 Arguments :
3356 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3357 referenced in section 9.
3358
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003359 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003360 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003361 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3362 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003363
3364 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3365 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3366
3367 Example:
3368 listen
3369 bind *:80
3370
3371 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3372 filter compression
3373 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3374
3375 compression algo gzip
3376 compression offload
3377
3378 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3379
3380 See also : section 9.
3381
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003382
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003383fullconn <conns>
3384 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 yes | no | yes | yes
3387 Arguments :
3388 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3389 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3390
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003391 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003393 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003394 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3395 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3396 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3397 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3398 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003399 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003400
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003401 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3402 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003403 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3404 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3405 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003406
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003407 Example :
3408 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3409 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3410 # connections.
3411 backend dynamic
3412 fullconn 10000
3413 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3414 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3415
3416 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3417
3418
3419grace <time>
3420 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003422 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423 Arguments :
3424 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3425 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3426 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3427
3428 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3429 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003430 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003431 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3432
3433 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3434 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3435 simplify it.
3436
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003437
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003438hash-balance-factor <factor>
3439 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 yes | no | no | yes
3442 Arguments :
3443 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3444 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3445 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3446
3447 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3448 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3449 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3450 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3451 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3452 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3453 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3454
3455 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3456 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3457 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3458 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3459 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3460
3461 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3462
3463
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003464hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003465 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3467 yes | no | yes | yes
3468 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003469 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3470 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003471
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003472 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3473 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3474 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3475 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3476 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3477 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3478 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3479 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3480 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3481 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003482
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003483 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3484 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3485 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3486 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3487 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3488 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3489 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3490 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3491 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3492 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3493 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3494 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3495 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003496 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3497 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003498
3499 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3500
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003501 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003502 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3503 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3504 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003505 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3506 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3507 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003508
3509 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3510 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003511 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3512 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3513 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3514 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3515
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003516 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3517 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3518 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3519 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3520 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3521 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3522 parameter.
3523
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003524 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3525 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3526 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3527 used on strings.
3528
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003529 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3530
3531 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3532 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3533 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3534 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3535 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3536 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3537 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3538 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3539 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3540 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3541 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3542 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003543
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003544 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3545 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3546 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003547
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003548 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003549
3550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003551http-check disable-on-404
3552 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003554 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003555 Arguments : none
3556
3557 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3558 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3559 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3560 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3561 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3562 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3563 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3564 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003565 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3566 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3567 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3568
3569 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3570
3571
3572http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003573 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003575 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003576 Arguments :
3577 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3578 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003579 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003580 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3581 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3582 details on the supported keywords.
3583
3584 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3585 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3586 with the usual backslash ('\').
3587
3588 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3589 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3590 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3591 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3592 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3593
3594 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003595 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003596 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3597 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3598 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3599
3600 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003601 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003602 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3603 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3604 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3605 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3606
3607 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003608 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003609 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3610 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3611 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3612 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3613 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3614 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3615 trace).
3616
3617 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003618 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003619 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3620 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3621 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3622 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3623 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3624 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3625
3626 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3627 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3628 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3629 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3630 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3631 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3632 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3633 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3634
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003635 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3636 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3637 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3638
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003639 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3640 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3641
3642 Examples :
3643 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003644 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003645
3646 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003647 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003648
3649 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003650 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003651
3652 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003653 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003654
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003655 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003656
3657
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003658http-check send-state
3659 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3661 yes | no | yes | yes
3662 Arguments : none
3663
3664 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3665 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3666 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3667 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3668 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3669
3670 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3671 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3672 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3673 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3674 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003675 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3676 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3677 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3678
3679 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3680 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3681 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3682
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003683 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3684 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3685 checked in multiple backends.
3686
3687 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3688 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3689
3690 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3691 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3692 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3693 one fails.
3694
3695 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3696 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3697 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3698
3699 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3700 server's queue.
3701
3702 Example of a header received by the application server :
3703 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3704 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3705
3706 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3707
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003708http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3709 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003710 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003711 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003712 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003713 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3714 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003715 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3716 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003717 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3718 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3719 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003720 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003721 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003722 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003723 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003724 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003725 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003726 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003727 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003728 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003729 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3730
3731 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3732 no | yes | yes | yes
3733
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003734 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3735 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3736 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3737 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3738 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003739
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003740 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3741 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3742 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3743
3744 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003745 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3746 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3747 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3748 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003749
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003750 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3751 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3752 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003753 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3754 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003755 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3756 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3757 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3758 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3759 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003760 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003761 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3762 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003763
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003764 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3765 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3766 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3767 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3768 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3769
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003770 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3771 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3772 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003773 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3774 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003775
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003776 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3777 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3778 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3779 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3780 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3781 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3782 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3783 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3784
3785 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3786 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3787 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003788 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3789 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003790
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003791 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3792 <name>.
3793
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003794 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3795 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3796 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3797 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3798 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3799 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3800 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3801 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3802
3803 Example:
3804
3805 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3806
3807 applied to:
3808
3809 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3810
3811 outputs:
3812
3813 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3814
3815 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3816
3817 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3818 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3819 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3820 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3821 header.
3822
3823 Example:
3824
3825 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3826
3827 applied to:
3828
3829 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3830
3831 outputs:
3832
3833 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3834
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003835 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3836 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3837 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3838 it.
3839
3840 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3841 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3842 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3843 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3844 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3845 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3846
3847 Example :
3848 # prepend the host name before the path
3849 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3850
3851 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3852 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3853 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3854 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3855 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3856 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3857 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3858 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3859
3860 Example :
3861 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3862 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3863
3864 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3865 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3866 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3867 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3868 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3869 "set-query".
3870
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003871 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3872 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3873 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3874 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3875 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3876 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3877 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3878 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3879
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003880 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3881 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3882 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3883 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3884 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3885 another equipment.
3886
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003887 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3888 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3889 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3890 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3891 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3892 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3893 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3894 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3895
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003896 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3897 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3898 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3899 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3900 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3901 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3902 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3903 admin privileges.
3904
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003905 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3906 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3907 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3908 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3909 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3910 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3911 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3912 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3913
3914 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3915 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3916 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3917 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3918 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3919 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3920
3921 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3922 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3923 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3924 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3925 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3926 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3927
3928 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3929 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3930 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3931 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3932 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3933 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3934 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3935 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3936 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3937
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003938 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003939 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3940 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3941 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3942 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3943 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3944 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3945 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3946 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3947 request header" for more information.
3948
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003949 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3950 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3951 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3952 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003953 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3954 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003955
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003956 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3957 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3958 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3959 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3960 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3961 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3962 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3963 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3964 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3965 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3966 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3967 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3968
3969 These actions take one or two arguments :
3970 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3971 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3972 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3973 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3974
3975 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3976 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3977 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3978 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3979
3980 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3981 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3982 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3983 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3984 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3985 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3986 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3987 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3988
3989 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3990 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3991 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3992 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3993 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3994
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003995 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3996 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3997 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3998 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3999 continues.
4000
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004001 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4002 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4003 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4004 the actions evaluation continues.
4005
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004006 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4007 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4008 inline.
4009
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004010 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4011 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004012 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004013 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4014 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004015 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004016 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004017 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004018 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4019 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004021 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004022 and '_'.
4023
4024 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4025 followed by some converters.
4026
4027 Example:
4028
4029 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4030
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004031 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4032 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4033
4034 Example:
4035
4036 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4037
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004038 - set-src <expr> :
4039 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4040 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4041 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4042 source IP for privacy.
4043
4044 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4045 followed by some converters.
4046
4047 Example:
4048
4049 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4050 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4051
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004052 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4053 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004054
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004055 - set-src-port <expr> :
4056 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4057 expression.
4058
4059 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4060 followed by some converters.
4061
4062 Example:
4063
4064 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4065 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4066
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004067 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4068 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4069 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004070
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004071 - set-dst <expr> :
4072 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4073 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4074 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4075 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4076 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4077
4078 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4079 followed by some converters.
4080
4081 Example:
4082
4083 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4084 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4085
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004086 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4087 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4088
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004089 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4090 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4091 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4092 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4093
4094 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4095 followed by some converters.
4096
4097 Example:
4098
4099 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4100 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4101
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004102 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4103 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4104 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4105
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004106 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4107 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4108 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4109 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4110 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4111 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4112 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4113 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4114 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4115 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4116 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4117 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4118 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4119 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4120 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4121 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4122
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004123 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4124
4125 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4126 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004127 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4128 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4129
4130 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4131 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4132 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4133 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004134
4135 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004136 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4137 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4138 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004139
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004140 http-request allow if nagios
4141 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4142 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4143 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004144
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004145 Example:
4146 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004147 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004148
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004149 Example:
4150 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4151 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004152 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004153 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4154 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4155 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4156 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4157 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4158 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4159
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004160 Example:
4161 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4162 acl add path /addacl
4163 acl del path /delacl
4164
4165 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4166
4167 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4168 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4169
4170 Example:
4171 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4172 acl setmap path /setmap
4173 acl delmap path /delmap
4174
4175 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4176
4177 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4178 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4179
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004180 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4181 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004182
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004183http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004184 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004185 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004186 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4187 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004188 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004189 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4190 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4191 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4192 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004193 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004194 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004195 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004196 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004197 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004198 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004199 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004200 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004201 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004202 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4203
4204 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 no | yes | yes | yes
4206
4207 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4208 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4209 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4210 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4211 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4212 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4213
4214 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4215 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4216 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4217 current section.
4218
4219 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4220 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4221 rules are evaluated.
4222
4223 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4224 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4225 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4226 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4227 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4228 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4229 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4230
4231 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4232 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4233 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4234 external users.
4235
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004236 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4237 <name>.
4238
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004239 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4240 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4241 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4242 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4243 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4244 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4245 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4246 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4247
4248 Example:
4249
4250 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4251
4252 applied to:
4253
4254 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4255
4256 outputs:
4257
4258 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4259
4260 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4261
4262 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4263 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4264 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4265 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4266 header.
4267
4268 Example:
4269
4270 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4271
4272 applied to:
4273
4274 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4275
4276 outputs:
4277
4278 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4279
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004280 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004281 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4282 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4283 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004284
4285 Example:
4286
4287 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4288 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004289 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4290 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004291
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004292 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4293 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4294 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4295 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4296 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4297 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4298 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4299 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4300
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004301 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4302 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4303 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4304 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4305 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4306 another equipment.
4307
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004308 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4309 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4310 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4311 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4312 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4313 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4314 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4315 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4316
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004317 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4318 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4319 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4320 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4321 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4322 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4323 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4324 admin privileges.
4325
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004326 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4327 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4328 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4329 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4330 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4331 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4332 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4333 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4334
4335 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4336 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4337 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4338 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4339 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4340 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4341
4342 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4343 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4344 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4345 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4346 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4347 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4348
4349 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4350 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4351 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4352 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4353 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4354 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4355 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4356 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4357 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4358
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004359 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4360 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4361 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4362 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4363 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4364 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4365 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4366 response header" for more information.
4367
4368 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4369 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4370 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4371 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4372 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004373 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4374 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004375
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004376 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4377 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4378 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4379 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4380 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4381 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4382
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004383 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4384 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4385 inline.
4386
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004387 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4388 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004389 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004390 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4391 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004392 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004393 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004394 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004395 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4396 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004397 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004398 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4399 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004400
4401 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4402 followed by some converters.
4403
4404 Example:
4405
4406 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4407
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004408 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4409 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4410
4411 Example:
4412
4413 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4414
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004415 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4416 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4417 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4418 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4419 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4420 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4421 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4422
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004423 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4424 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4425 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4426 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4427 continues.
4428
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004429 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4430 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4431 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4432 the actions evaluation continues.
4433
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004434 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4435 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4436 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4437 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4438 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4439 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4440 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4441 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4442 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4443 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4444 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4445 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4446 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4447 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4448 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4449 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4450
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004451 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4452
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004453 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004454 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4455 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004456 rules.
4457
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004458 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4459 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4460 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4461 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4462
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004463 Example:
4464 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4465
4466 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4467
4468 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4469 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4470
4471 Example:
4472 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4473
4474 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4475
4476 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4477 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4478
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004479 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4480 ACL usage.
4481
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004482
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004483http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4484 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4485
4486 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4487 yes | no | yes | yes
4488
4489 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4490 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4491 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4492 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4493 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4494 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4495
4496 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4497
4498 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4499 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4500 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4501 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4502 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4503 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4504 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4505 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4506 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4507 not checking any request past the first one.
4508
4509 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4510 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4511 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4512 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4513 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4514 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4515 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4516
4517 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4518 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4519 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4520 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4521 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4522 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4523 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4524 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4525 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4526 downsides of rare connection failures.
4527
4528 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4529 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4530 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4531 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4532 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4533 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4534 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4535 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4536 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4537 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4538 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4539 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4540
4541 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4542 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4543 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4544 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4545
4546 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4547 and are never shared ;
4548
4549 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4550 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4551 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4552 and are never shared ;
4553
4554 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4555 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4556 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4557
4558 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4559 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4560 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4561
4562 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4563
4564
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004565http-send-name-header [<header>]
4566 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4567
4568 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 yes | no | yes | yes
4570
4571 Arguments :
4572
4573 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4574
4575 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4576 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4577 is added with the header string proved.
4578
4579 See also : "server"
4580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004581id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004582 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 no | yes | yes | yes
4585 Arguments : none
4586
4587 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4588 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4589 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004590
4591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004592ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4593 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4595 no | yes | yes | yes
4596
4597 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4598 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4599 and running).
4600
4601 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4602 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4603 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004604 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004605 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4606
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004607 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4608 "unless" condition is met.
4609
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004610 Example:
4611 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4612 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4613 ignore-persist if url_static
4614
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004615 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4616
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004617load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4618 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | no | yes | yes
4621
4622 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4623 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4624 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4625 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4626 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4627 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4628 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4629 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4630
4631 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4632 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004633 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004634
4635 Arguments:
4636 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4637 named "server-state-file".
4638
4639 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4640 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4641 name is used as a file name.
4642
4643 none don't load any stat for this backend
4644
4645 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004646 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4647 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4648 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4649 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4650 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004651
4652 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4653 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004655 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004656
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004657 global
4658 stats socket /tmp/socket
4659 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004660
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004661 defaults
4662 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004663
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004664 backend bk
4665 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4666 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004667
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004668
4669 Then one can run :
4670
4671 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4672
4673 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4674
4675 1
4676 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4677 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4678 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004680 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004681
4682 global
4683 stats socket /tmp/socket
4684 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4685
4686 defaults
4687 load-server-state-from-file local
4688
4689 backend bk
4690 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4691 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004693
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004694 Then one can run :
4695
4696 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4697
4698 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4699
4700 1
4701 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4702 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4703 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4704
4705 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4706 "show servers state"
4707
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004708
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004709log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004710log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004711no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004712 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004715
4716 Prefix :
4717 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4718 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4719 prefix does not allow arguments.
4720
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004721 Arguments :
4722 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4723 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4724 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4725 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4726 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4727 parameter.
4728
4729 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4730 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4731
4732 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4733 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4734 standard syslog port).
4735
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004736 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4737 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4738 standard syslog port).
4739
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004740 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4741 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4742 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4743 appropriately writeable).
4744
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004745 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4746 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004747
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004748 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4749 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4750 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4751 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4752 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4753 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4754 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4755 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4756 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4757 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4758 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4759
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4761
4762 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4763 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4764 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4765
4766 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4767 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4768 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004769 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4770 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4771 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4772 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4773 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004774
4775 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4776
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004777 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4778 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4779 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004780
4781 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4782 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4783 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4784 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4785
4786 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4787 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004788
4789 Example :
4790 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004791 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4792 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004793 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004794
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004795
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004796log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004797 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4798 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4799 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004800
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004801 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4802 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4803 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4804 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4805 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004806
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004807 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4808 "option httplog" directives.
4809
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004810log-format-sd <string>
4811 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4813 yes | yes | yes | no
4814
4815 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4816 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4817 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4818 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4819 which covers the log format string in depth.
4820
4821 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4822 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4823
4824 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4825 log format to "rfc5424".
4826
4827 Example :
4828 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4829
4830
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004831log-tag <string>
4832 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4833 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
4835
4836 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4837 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4838 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4839 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4840 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4841 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4842 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4843 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4844 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004845
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004846max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4847 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | no | yes | yes
4850
4851 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4852 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4853 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4854 servers.
4855
4856 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4857 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4858 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4859 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4860 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4861 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4862 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4863 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4864 picking a different server.
4865
4866 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4867 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4868 even if they have to be queued.
4869
4870 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4871 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4872
4873
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874maxconn <conns>
4875 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 yes | yes | yes | no
4878 Arguments :
4879 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4880 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4881 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4882 closes.
4883
4884 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4885 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4886 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4887 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004888 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4889 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4890 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4891 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892
4893 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4894 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4895 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4896
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004897 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4898
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4900
4901
4902mode { tcp|http|health }
4903 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4905 yes | yes | yes | yes
4906 Arguments :
4907 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4908 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4909 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4910 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4911
4912 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4913 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4914 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4915 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4916 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4917
4918 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004919 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4920 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4921 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4922 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4923 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4924 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4925 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004927 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4928 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4929 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004930
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004931 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932 defaults http_instances
4933 mode http
4934
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004935 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004936
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004937
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004938monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004939 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4941 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004942 Arguments :
4943 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4944 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004945 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004946 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4947 backend and its backup.
4948
4949 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4950 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4951 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4952 servers in a list of backends.
4953
4954 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4955 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4956 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4957 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4958 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4959 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4960 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004961 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4962 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004963
4964 Example:
4965 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004966 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004967 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4968 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4969 monitor-uri /site_alive
4970 monitor fail if site_dead
4971
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004972 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004973
4974
4975monitor-net <source>
4976 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | no
4979 Arguments :
4980 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4981 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4982 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4983 followed by a mask.
4984
4985 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4986 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004987 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004988 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4989
4990 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4991 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4992 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4993 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004994 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4995 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4996 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004997
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004998 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4999 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5000 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5001 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5002 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5003 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005004
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005005 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5006 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005007
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005008 Example :
5009 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5010 frontend www
5011 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5012
5013 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5014
5015
5016monitor-uri <uri>
5017 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5019 yes | yes | yes | no
5020 Arguments :
5021 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5022 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5023
5024 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5025 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5026 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5027 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5028 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5029 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5030 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5031 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5032
5033 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5034 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5035 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5036 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5037 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5038 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5039
5040 Example :
5041 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5042 frontend www
5043 mode http
5044 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5045
5046 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5047
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005048
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005049option abortonclose
5050no option abortonclose
5051 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5053 yes | no | yes | yes
5054 Arguments : none
5055
5056 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5057 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5058 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5059 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005060 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005061 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5062 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5063 encountered while delivering the response.
5064
5065 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5066 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5067 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5068 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5069 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5070 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005071 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005072 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005073 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005074 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5075 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5076 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5077
5078 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5079 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5080 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5081 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5082 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5083 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5084 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5085 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005086 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005087
5088 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5089 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5090
5091 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5092
5093
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005094option accept-invalid-http-request
5095no option accept-invalid-http-request
5096 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5098 yes | yes | yes | no
5099 Arguments : none
5100
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005101 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005102 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5103 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5104 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5105 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5106 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5107 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5108 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005109 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5110 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5111 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5112 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5113 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005114 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005115 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5116 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5117 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005118
5119 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5120 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5121 been confirmed.
5122
5123 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5124 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005125 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5126 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005127 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5128
5129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5131
5132 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5133 stats socket.
5134
5135
5136option accept-invalid-http-response
5137no option accept-invalid-http-response
5138 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5140 yes | no | yes | yes
5141 Arguments : none
5142
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005143 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005144 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5145 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5146 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5147 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5148 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5149 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5150 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005151 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5152 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5153 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005154
5155 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5156 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5157 been confirmed.
5158
5159 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5160 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5161 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5162 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5163
5164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5166
5167 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5168 stats socket.
5169
5170
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005171option allbackups
5172no option allbackups
5173 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5175 yes | no | yes | yes
5176 Arguments : none
5177
5178 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5179 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5180 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5181 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5182 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5183 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5184 order between the backup servers anymore.
5185
5186 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5187 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5188
5189 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5190 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5191
5192
5193option checkcache
5194no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005195 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5197 yes | no | yes | yes
5198 Arguments : none
5199
5200 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5201 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005202 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005203 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5204 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005205 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005206
5207 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005208 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005209 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005210 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5211 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005212 to the client are :
5213 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005214 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005215 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005216 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5217 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5218 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5219 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5220 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5221 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5222 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5223 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5224 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5225 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5226 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5227
5228 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005229 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005230 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005231 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005232 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5233
5234 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5235 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005236 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005237 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5238
5239 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5240 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5241
5242
5243option clitcpka
5244no option clitcpka
5245 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5247 yes | yes | yes | no
5248 Arguments : none
5249
5250 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5251 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5252 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5253 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5254
5255 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5256 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5257 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5258 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5259
5260 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5261 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5262 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5263 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5264 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5265
5266 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5267
5268 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5269 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5270 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5271
5272 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5273 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5274
5275 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5276
5277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005278option contstats
5279 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5281 yes | yes | yes | no
5282 Arguments : none
5283
5284 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5285 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5286 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5287 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005288 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5289 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5290 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5291 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5292 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005293
5294
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005295option dontlog-normal
5296no option dontlog-normal
5297 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5299 yes | yes | yes | no
5300 Arguments : none
5301
5302 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5303 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5304 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5305 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5306 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5307 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5308 logged.
5309
5310 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5311 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5312 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005314 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005315 logging.
5316
5317
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005318option dontlognull
5319no option dontlognull
5320 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5322 yes | yes | yes | no
5323 Arguments : none
5324
5325 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5326 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5327 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5328 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5329 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5330 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005331 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5332 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5333 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005334
5335 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5336 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5337 would not be logged.
5338
5339 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5340 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5341
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005342 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5343 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005344
5345
5346option forceclose
5347no option forceclose
5348 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005350 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005351 Arguments : none
5352
5353 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5354 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5355 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5356 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5357 global session times in the logs.
5358
5359 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005360 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005361 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005362
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005363 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5364 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5365 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5366
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005367 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5368 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005369
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005370 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5371 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5372
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005373 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005374
5375
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005376option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005377 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5379 yes | yes | yes | yes
5380 Arguments :
5381 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5382 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005383 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005384 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005385
5386 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5387 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5388 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5389 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5390 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5391 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5392 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005393 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5394 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5395 possible that the client has already brought one.
5396
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005397 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005398 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005399 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5400 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005401 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5402 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005403
5404 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5405 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5406 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5407 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5408 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5409 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5410 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5411
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005412 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5413 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5414 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5415 are under the control of the end-user.
5416
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005417 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005418 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5419 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005420 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5421 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5422 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005423
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005424 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005425 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5426 frontend www
5427 mode http
5428 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5429
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005430 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5431 backend www
5432 mode http
5433 option forwardfor header X-Client
5434
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005435 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005436 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005437
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005438
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005439option http-buffer-request
5440no option http-buffer-request
5441 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5443 yes | yes | yes | yes
5444 Arguments : none
5445
5446 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5447 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5448 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5449 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5450 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5451 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5452 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5453 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005454 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005455 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5456 default.
5457
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005458 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005459
5460
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005461option http-ignore-probes
5462no option http-ignore-probes
5463 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5465 yes | yes | yes | no
5466 Arguments : none
5467
5468 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5469 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5470 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5471 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5472 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5473 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5474 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5475 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5476 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5477 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5478 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5479 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5480
5481 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5482 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5483 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5484 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5485 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5486 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5487 are often the only way to detect them.
5488
5489 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5490 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5491
5492 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5493
5494
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005495option http-keep-alive
5496no option http-keep-alive
5497 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 yes | yes | yes | yes
5500 Arguments : none
5501
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005502 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5503 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5504 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5505 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5506 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5507 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5508 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5509
5510 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5511 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005512 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5513 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5514 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5515 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5516 situations where this option may be useful :
5517
5518 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5519 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5520
5521 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5522 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5523
5524 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5525 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5526 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5527 request.
5528
5529 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5530 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005531 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5532 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5533 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005534
5535 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5536 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5537
5538 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5539 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5540 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5541 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5542 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5543 not set.
5544
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005545 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5546 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005547 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005548 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005549
5550 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005551 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5552 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005553
5554
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005555option http-no-delay
5556no option http-no-delay
5557 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5559 yes | yes | yes | yes
5560 Arguments : none
5561
5562 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5563 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5564 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5565 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5566 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5567 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5568 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5569 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5570 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5571 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5572 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5573 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5574 affected.
5575
5576 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5577 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5578 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5579 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5580 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5581 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5582 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5583 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5584 latency environments.
5585
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005586 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5587
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005588
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005589option http-pretend-keepalive
5590no option http-pretend-keepalive
5591 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5593 yes | yes | yes | yes
5594 Arguments : none
5595
5596 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5597 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5598 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5599 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5600 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5601 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5602 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5603 consider the response complete.
5604
5605 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5606 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5607 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5608 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5609 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5610 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5611
5612 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5613 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5614 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5615 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5616 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5617 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5618 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5619
5620 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5621 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005622 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005623 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5624 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005625
5626 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5627 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5628
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005629 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5630 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005631
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005632
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005633option http-server-close
5634no option http-server-close
5635 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5637 yes | yes | yes | yes
5638 Arguments : none
5639
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005640 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5641 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5642 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5643 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5644 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5645 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5646 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5647 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5648 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5649 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5650 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5651 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5652 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5653 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5654 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5655 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005656
5657 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5658 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5659 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5660 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005661 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5662 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005663
5664 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5665 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005666 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5667 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005668 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5669 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005670
5671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5673
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005674 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005675 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5676 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005677
5678
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005679option http-tunnel
5680no option http-tunnel
5681 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5683 yes | yes | yes | yes
5684 Arguments : none
5685
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005686 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5687 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5688 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5689 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5690 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5691 "option http-tunnel".
5692
5693 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005694 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005695 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5696 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5697 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5698 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5699 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5700 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5701 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005702
5703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5705
5706 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5707 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5708 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5709
5710
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005711option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005712no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005713 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5715 yes | yes | yes | no
5716 Arguments : none
5717
5718 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5719 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5720 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5721 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5722 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5723 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5724 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5725
5726 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5727 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005728 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5729 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5730 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005731
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005732 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5733 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5734 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5735 front of an existing proxy.
5736
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005737 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5738
5739 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5740 http-server-close".
5741
5742
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005743option httpchk
5744option httpchk <uri>
5745option httpchk <method> <uri>
5746option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5747 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5749 yes | no | yes | yes
5750 Arguments :
5751 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5752 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5753 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5754 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5755 ones.
5756
5757 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5758 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5759 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5760
5761 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5762 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5763 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5764 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5765 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5766
5767 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5768 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5769 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5770 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5771 the lack of any response.
5772
5773 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5774
5775 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5776 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5777 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5778
5779 Examples :
5780 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5781 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5782 backend https_relay
5783 mode tcp
5784 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5785 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5786
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005787 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5788 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5789 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005790
5791
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005792option httpclose
5793no option httpclose
5794 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5796 yes | yes | yes | yes
5797 Arguments : none
5798
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005799 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5800 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5801 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5802 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005803 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005804 "option http-tunnel".
5805
5806 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5807 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5808 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5809 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5810 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5811 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5812 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5813 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005814
5815 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005816 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005817 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5818 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5819 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5820 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5821 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005822
5823 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5824 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005825 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5826 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005827 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5828 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005829
5830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5832
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005833 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5834 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005835
5836
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005837option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005838 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5840 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005841 Arguments :
5842 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5843 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5844 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5845 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5846 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005847
5848 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5849 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5850 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5851 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5852 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5853 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5854 ports.
5855
5856 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5857
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005858 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5859 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005860
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005861 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005863 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005864
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005865
5866option http_proxy
5867no option http_proxy
5868 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5870 yes | yes | yes | yes
5871 Arguments : none
5872
5873 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5874 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5875 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5876 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5877 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5878
5879 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5880 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005881 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5882 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005883
5884 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5885 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5886
5887 Example :
5888 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5889 backend direct_forward
5890 option httpclose
5891 option http_proxy
5892
5893 See also : "option httpclose"
5894
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005895
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005896option independent-streams
5897no option independent-streams
5898 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 yes | yes | yes | yes
5901 Arguments : none
5902
5903 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5904 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5905 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5906 receive data or not.
5907
5908 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5909 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5910 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5911 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5912 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5913 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5914 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5915 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5916 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5917 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5918 socket buffers.
5919
5920 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5921 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5922 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5923 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5924 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5925
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005926 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005927 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5928 deprecated.
5929
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005930 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005931
5932
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005933option ldap-check
5934 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | no | yes | yes
5937 Arguments : none
5938
5939 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5940 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5941 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5942 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5943
5944 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5945 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5946
5947 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5948 configure it.
5949
5950 Example :
5951 option ldap-check
5952
5953 See also : "option httpchk"
5954
5955
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005956option external-check
5957 Use external processes for server health checks
5958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5959 yes | no | yes | yes
5960
5961 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5962 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5963 command".
5964
5965 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5966
5967 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5968
5969
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005970option log-health-checks
5971no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005972 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 yes | no | yes | yes
5975 Arguments : none
5976
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005977 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5978 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5979 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005980
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005981 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5982 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5983 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5984 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5985 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5986
5987 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5988 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005989
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005990 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5991 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5992 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005993
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005994
5995option log-separate-errors
5996no option log-separate-errors
5997 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5999 yes | yes | yes | no
6000 Arguments : none
6001
6002 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6003 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6004 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6005 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6006 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6007 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6008 provides very important information.
6009
6010 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6011 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6012 error logs.
6013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006014 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006015 logging.
6016
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006017
6018option logasap
6019no option logasap
6020 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6022 yes | yes | yes | no
6023 Arguments : none
6024
6025 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6026 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6027 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6028 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6029 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6030 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6031 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006032 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006033 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6034 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006036 Examples :
6037 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6038 mode http
6039 option httplog
6040 option logasap
6041 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6042
6043 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6044 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6045 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6046 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006048 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006049 logging.
6050
6051
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006052option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006053 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6055 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006056 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006057 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6058 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006059 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006060
6061 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6062 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6063 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6064 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6065 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6066 in the MySQL table, like this :
6067
6068 USE mysql;
6069 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6070 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6071
6072 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6073 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6074 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6075 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6076 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6077 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6078 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6079 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6080 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6081
6082 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6083 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006084
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006085 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006086
6087 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6088 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6089 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6090 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006091 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6092 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006093
6094 See also: "option httpchk"
6095
6096
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006097option nolinger
6098no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006099 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006100 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6101 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006102 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006103
6104 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6105 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6106 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6107 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6108 connections.
6109
6110 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6111 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6112 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6113 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6114 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6115 this too.
6116
6117 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6118 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6119 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6120
6121 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6122 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6123 for servers.
6124
6125 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6126 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6127
6128
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006129option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6130 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6132 yes | yes | yes | yes
6133 Arguments :
6134 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6135 matching <network>
6136 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6137 header name.
6138
6139 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6140 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6141 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6142 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6143 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6144 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6145 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6146 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6147 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6148 possible that the client has already brought one.
6149
6150 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6151 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6152 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6153 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6154 header and requires different one.
6155
6156 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6157 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6158 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6159 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6160 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6161 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6162 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6163
6164 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6165 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6166 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6167 both are defined.
6168
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006169 Examples :
6170 # Original Destination address
6171 frontend www
6172 mode http
6173 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6174
6175 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6176 backend www
6177 mode http
6178 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6179
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006180 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6181 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006182
6183
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006184option persist
6185no option persist
6186 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6188 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006189 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006190
6191 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6192 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6193 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6194 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6195 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6196 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6197 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6198 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6199 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6200 redirected to another valid server.
6201
6202 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6203 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6204
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006205 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006206
6207
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006208option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6209 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6211 yes | no | yes | yes
6212 Arguments :
6213 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6214 PostgreSQL server.
6215
6216 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6217 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6218 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6219 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6220
6221 See also: "option httpchk"
6222
6223
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006224option prefer-last-server
6225no option prefer-last-server
6226 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6227 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | no | yes | yes
6229 Arguments : none
6230
6231 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6232 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6233 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6234 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6235 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6236 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6237 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6238 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6239 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006240 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6241 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6242 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6243 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6244 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6245 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6246 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006247
6248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6250
6251 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6252
6253
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006254option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006255option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006256no option redispatch
6257 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6258 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6259 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006260 Arguments :
6261 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6262 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6263 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6264 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6265 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6266 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6267 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6268 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6269 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006271
6272 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6273 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6274 be able to access the service anymore.
6275
6276 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6277 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6278
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006279 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006280 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6281 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006283 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6284 "redisp" keywords.
6285
6286 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6287 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6288
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006289 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006290
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006291
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006292option redis-check
6293 Use redis health checks for server testing
6294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6295 yes | no | yes | yes
6296 Arguments : none
6297
6298 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6299 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6300 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6301 find the "+PONG" response message.
6302
6303 Example :
6304 option redis-check
6305
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006306 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006307
6308
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006309option smtpchk
6310option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6311 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6313 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006314 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006315 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6316 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6317 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6318
6319 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6320 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6321 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6322
6323 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6324 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6325 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6326 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6327 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6328 dead server.
6329
6330 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6331 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6332 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6333 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6334
6335 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6336 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6337 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6338 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006339 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006340
6341 Example :
6342 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6343
6344 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6345
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006347option socket-stats
6348no option socket-stats
6349
6350 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 yes | yes | yes | no
6353
6354 Arguments : none
6355
6356
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006357option splice-auto
6358no option splice-auto
6359 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | yes | yes | yes
6362 Arguments : none
6363
6364 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6365 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6366 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6367 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006368 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006369 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6370 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6371 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6372 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6373
6374 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6375 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6376 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6377 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6378 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6379 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6380 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6381 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6382 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6383 keyword.
6384
6385 Example :
6386 option splice-auto
6387
6388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6390
6391 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6392 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6393
6394
6395option splice-request
6396no option splice-request
6397 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6399 yes | yes | yes | yes
6400 Arguments : none
6401
6402 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006403 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006404 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6405 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6406 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6407 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6408
6409 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6410
6411 Example :
6412 option splice-request
6413
6414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6416
6417 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6418 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6419
6420
6421option splice-response
6422no option splice-response
6423 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6425 yes | yes | yes | yes
6426 Arguments : none
6427
6428 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006429 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006430 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6431 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6432 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6433 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6434
6435 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6436
6437 Example :
6438 option splice-response
6439
6440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6442
6443 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6444 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6445
6446
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006447option spop-check
6448 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6450 no | no | no | yes
6451 Arguments : none
6452
6453 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6454 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6455 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6456 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6457
6458 Example :
6459 option spop-check
6460
6461 See also : "option httpchk"
6462
6463
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006464option srvtcpka
6465no option srvtcpka
6466 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6467 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6468 yes | no | yes | yes
6469 Arguments : none
6470
6471 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6472 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6473 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6474 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6475
6476 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6477 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6478 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6479 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6480
6481 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6482 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6483 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6484 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6485 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6486
6487 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6488
6489 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6490 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6491 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6492
6493 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6494 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6495
6496 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6497
6498
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006499option ssl-hello-chk
6500 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6502 yes | no | yes | yes
6503 Arguments : none
6504
6505 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6506 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6507 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6508 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6509 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6510 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6511 hello message.
6512
6513 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6514 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6515 messages, which is appreciable.
6516
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006517 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6518 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6519 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006520
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006521 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6522
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006523
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006524option tcp-check
6525 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6526 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6527 yes | no | yes | yes
6528
6529 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6530 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6531
6532 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6533 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6534 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6535
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006536 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006537 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6538 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6539 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6540 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6541 only.
6542
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006543 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006544 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6545 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6546 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6547 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6548
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006549 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006550 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6551 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006552 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006553 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6554 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6555 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6556 the respective protocols.
6557 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6558 analysed.
6559
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006560 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6561 script.
6562
6563 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6564 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6565 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6566 The "comment" is of course optional.
6567
6568
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006569 Examples :
6570 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6571 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006572 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006573
6574 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6575 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006576 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006577
6578 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6579 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006580 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006581 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006582 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006583 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006584 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006585 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006586 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6587 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006588 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006589 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6590 tcp-check expect string +OK
6591
6592 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6593 (send many headers before analyzing)
6594 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006595 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006596 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6597 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6598 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6599 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006600 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006601
6602
6603 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6604
6605
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006606option tcp-smart-accept
6607no option tcp-smart-accept
6608 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6610 yes | yes | yes | no
6611 Arguments : none
6612
6613 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6614 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6615 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6616 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6617 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6618 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6619
6620 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6621 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6622 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6623 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6624
6625 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6626 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6627 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6628 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6629
6630 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6631 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6632 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6633
6634 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6635 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6636 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6637
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006638 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6639
6640
6641option tcp-smart-connect
6642no option tcp-smart-connect
6643 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6645 yes | no | yes | yes
6646 Arguments : none
6647
6648 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6649 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6650 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6651 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6652 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6653
6654 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6655 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6656 complex.
6657
6658 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6659 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6660 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6661
6662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6664
6665 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6666
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006667
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006668option tcpka
6669 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6671 yes | yes | yes | yes
6672 Arguments : none
6673
6674 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6675 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6676 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6677 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6678
6679 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6680 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6681 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6682 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6683
6684 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6685 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6686 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6687 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6688 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6689
6690 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6691
6692 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6693 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6694 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6695 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6696 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6697 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6698 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6699 backends.
6700
6701 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6702
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006703
6704option tcplog
6705 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6707 yes | yes | yes | yes
6708 Arguments : none
6709
6710 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6711 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6712 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6713 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6714 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6715 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6716 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6717 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6718
6719 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6720
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006721 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6722
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006723 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006724
6725
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006726option transparent
6727no option transparent
6728 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006730 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006731 Arguments : none
6732
6733 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6734 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6735 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6736 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6737 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6738 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6739 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6740 appropriate server.
6741
6742 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6743 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6744
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006745 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006746 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006747
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006748
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006749external-check command <command>
6750 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6752 yes | no | yes | yes
6753
6754 Arguments :
6755 <command> is the external command to run
6756
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006757 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6758
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006759 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006760
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006761 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6762 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6763 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6764 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6765 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6766 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006767
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006768 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6769
6770 Environment variables :
6771 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6772 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6773
6774 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6775
6776 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6777
6778 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6779 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6780 for a UNIX socket).
6781
6782 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6783
6784 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6785
6786 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6787
6788 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6789
6790 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6791
6792 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6793 socket).
6794
6795 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6796 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6797
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006798 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6799 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6800 failed.
6801
6802 Example :
6803 external-check command /bin/true
6804
6805 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6806
6807
6808external-check path <path>
6809 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6811 yes | no | yes | yes
6812
6813 Arguments :
6814 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6815
6816 The default path is "".
6817
6818 Example :
6819 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6820
6821 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6822 "external-check command"
6823
6824
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006825persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006826persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006827 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6829 yes | no | yes | yes
6830 Arguments :
6831 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006832 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6833 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006834
6835 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6836 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6837 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6838 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6839 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6840 forwarded to this server.
6841
6842 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6843 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6844 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006845 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006846 a single "listen" section.
6847
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006848 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6849 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6850 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6851
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006852 Example :
6853 listen tse-farm
6854 bind :3389
6855 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6856 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6857 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6858 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6859 persist rdp-cookie
6860 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006861 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006862 balance rdp-cookie
6863 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6864 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6865
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006866 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6867 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006868
6869
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006870rate-limit sessions <rate>
6871 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6873 yes | yes | yes | no
6874 Arguments :
6875 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6876 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6877
6878 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6879 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6880 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6881 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6882 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6883 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6884
6885 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6886 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6887 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6888 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6889
6890 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6891 listen smtp
6892 mode tcp
6893 bind :25
6894 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006895 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006896
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006897 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6898 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6899 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006900
6901 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6902
6903
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006904redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6905redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6906redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006907 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6909 no | yes | yes | yes
6910
6911 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006912 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006913
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006914 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006915 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006916 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6917 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6918 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006919
6920 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6921 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6922 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6923 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6924 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006925 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6926 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6927 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6928 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006929
6930 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6931 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6932 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6933 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6934 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6935 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006936 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006937 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006938 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6939 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6940 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006941
6942 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006943 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6944 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6945 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006946 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006947 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6948 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6949 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6950 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006951
6952 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6953 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6954
6955 - "drop-query"
6956 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6957 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6958 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6959 with a location-type redirect.
6960
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006961 - "append-slash"
6962 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6963 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6964 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6965 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6966
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006967 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6968 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6969 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6970 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6971 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6972 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6973 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6974
6975 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6976 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6977 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6978 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6979 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6980 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6981 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006982
6983 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6984 acl clear dst_port 80
6985 acl secure dst_port 8080
6986 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006987 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006988 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006989 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6990
6991 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006992 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6993 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6994 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006995 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006996
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006997 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6998 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6999 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7000
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007001 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007002 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007003
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007004 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007005 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7006 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7007 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007009 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007010
7011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007012redisp (deprecated)
7013redispatch (deprecated)
7014 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7015 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7016 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007017 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007018
7019 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7020 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7021 be able to access the service anymore.
7022
7023 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7024 redistribute them to a working server.
7025
7026 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7027 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7028 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007030 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7031 "option redispatch" instead.
7032
7033 See also : "option redispatch"
7034
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007035
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007036reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007037 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7039 no | yes | yes | yes
7040 Arguments :
7041 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7042 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007043 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007044
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007045 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7046 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7047
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007048 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7049 the last header of an HTTP request.
7050
7051 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7052 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7053 responses.
7054
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007055 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7056 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7057 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7058
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007059 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7060 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007061
7062
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007063reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7064reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007065 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 no | yes | yes | yes
7068 Arguments :
7069 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7070 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7071 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7072 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7073 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7074 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7075 ignores case.
7076
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007077 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7078 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7079
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007080 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7081 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7082 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7083 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007084 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007085
7086 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7087 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7088
7089 Example :
7090 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7091 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7092 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7093
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007094 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7095 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007096
7097
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007098reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7099reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007100 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7102 no | yes | yes | yes
7103 Arguments :
7104 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7105 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7106 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7107 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7108 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7109 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7110
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007111 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7112 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7113
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007114 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7115 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7116 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7117 next servers.
7118
7119 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7120 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7121 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7122
7123 Example :
7124 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7125 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7126 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7127
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007128 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7129 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007130
7131
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007132reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7133reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007134 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7136 no | yes | yes | yes
7137 Arguments :
7138 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7139 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7140 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7141 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7142 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7143 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7144 case.
7145
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007146 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7147 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7148
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007149 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7150 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7151 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7152 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007153 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007154
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007155 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007156 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007157 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007158
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007159 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7160 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7161
7162 Example :
7163 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7164 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7165 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7166
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007167 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7168 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007169
7170
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007171reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7172reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007173 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 no | yes | yes | yes
7176 Arguments :
7177 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7178 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7179 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7180 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7181 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7182 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7183 case.
7184
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007185 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7186 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7187
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007188 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7189 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7190 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7191 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7192
7193 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7194 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7195
7196 Example :
7197 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7198 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7199 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7200 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7201
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007202 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7203 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007204
7205
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007206reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7207reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007208 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7210 no | yes | yes | yes
7211 Arguments :
7212 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7213 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7214 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7215 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7216 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7217 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7218
7219 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7220 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7221 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7222 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007223 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007224
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007225 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7226 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7227
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007228 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7229 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7230 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7231
7232 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7233 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7234 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7235 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7236 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7237
7238 Example :
7239 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007240 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007241 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7242 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7243
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007244 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7245 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007246
7247
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007248reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7249reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007250 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7252 no | yes | yes | yes
7253 Arguments :
7254 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7255 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7256 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7257 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7258 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7259 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7260 ignores case.
7261
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007262 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7263 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7264
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007265 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7266 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007267 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7268 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7269 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007270 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7271 not set.
7272
7273 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7274 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7275 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7276 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7277 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7278
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007279 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7281 # block all others.
7282 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7283 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7284
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007285 # block bad guys
7286 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7287 reqitarpit . if badguys
7288
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007289 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7290 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007291
7292
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007293retries <value>
7294 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7295 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7296 yes | no | yes | yes
7297 Arguments :
7298 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7299 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7300 default value is 3.
7301
7302 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7303 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7304 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7305
7306 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007307 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7308 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007309
7310 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7311 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7312
7313 See also : "option redispatch"
7314
7315
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007316rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007317 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7319 no | yes | yes | yes
7320 Arguments :
7321 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7322 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007323 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007325 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7326 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7327
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007328 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7329 the last header of an HTTP response.
7330
7331 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7332 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7333 responses.
7334
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007335 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7336 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007337
7338
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007339rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7340rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007341 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7343 no | yes | yes | yes
7344 Arguments :
7345 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7346 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7347 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7348 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7349 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7350 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7351 ignores case.
7352
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007353 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7354 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7355
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007356 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7357 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007358 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007359 client.
7360
7361 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7362 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7363 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7364
7365 Example :
7366 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007367 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007368
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007369 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7370 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007371
7372
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007373rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7374rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007375 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7377 no | yes | yes | yes
7378 Arguments :
7379 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7380 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7381 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7382 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7383 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7384 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7385 ignores case.
7386
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007387 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7388 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7389
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007390 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7391 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7392 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7393 case-sensitive.
7394
7395 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007396 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7397 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7398 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007399
7400 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7401 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7402
7403 Example :
7404 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7405 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7406
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007407 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7408 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007409
7410
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007411rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7412rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007413 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7415 no | yes | yes | yes
7416 Arguments :
7417 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7418 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7419 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7420 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7421 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7422 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7423 ignores case.
7424
7425 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7426 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7427 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7428 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007429 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007430
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007431 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7432 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7433
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007434 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7435 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7436 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7437
7438 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7439 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7440 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7441 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7442 are not case-sensitive.
7443
7444 Example :
7445 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7446 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7447
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007448 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7449 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007450
7451
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007452server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007453 Declare a server in a backend
7454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7455 no | no | yes | yes
7456 Arguments :
7457 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007458 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007459 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007460
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007461 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7462 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7463 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7464 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007465 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7466 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7467 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7468 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7469 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007470 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7471 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7472 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7473 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7474 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7475 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7476 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007477 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007478 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7479 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007480 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7481 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007482
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007483 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007484 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7485 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7486 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7487 adding this value to the client's port.
7488
7489 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7490 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007491 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007492
7493 Examples :
7494 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7495 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007496 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007497 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7498 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7499 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007500
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007501 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7502 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7503 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7504 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7505 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7506
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007507 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7508 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007509
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007510server-state-file-name [<file>]
7511 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7512 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7513 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7514 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7515 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7516 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7517
7518 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7519 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7520
7521 global
7522 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7523
7524 backend bk
7525 load-server-state-from-file
7526
7527 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7528 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007529
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007530server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7531 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7532 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7534 no | no | yes | yes
7535
7536 Arguments:
7537 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7538
7539 <num | range>
7540 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7541 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7542 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7543 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7544
7545 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7546
7547 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7548
7549 <params*>
7550 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7551 keyword.
7552
7553 Examples:
7554 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7555 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7556 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7557
7558 # or
7559 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7560
7561 # would be equivalent to:
7562 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7563 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7564 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7565
7566
7567
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007568source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007569source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007570source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007571 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7573 yes | no | yes | yes
7574 Arguments :
7575 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7576 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007577
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007578 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007579 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7580 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7581 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7582 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7583 supported prefixes are :
7584 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7585 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7586 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007587 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007588 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7589 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007590
7591 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7592 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007593 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7594 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7595 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007596
7597 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7598 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7599 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7600 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7601 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7602 <addr>.
7603
7604 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7605 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7606 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7607 port.
7608
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007609 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7610 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7611 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7612 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007613 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007614 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7615 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7616 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7617 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7618 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7619 HTTP header.
7620
7621 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7622 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007623 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007624 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7625 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7626 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7627 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7628 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7629 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7630 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7631
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007632 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7633 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7634 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7635 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7636 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7637 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7638
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007639 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7640 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7641 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7642 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7643
7644 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7645 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7646 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7647 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7648 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7649 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7650
7651 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7652 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7653 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7654 there are two methods :
7655
7656 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7657 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7658 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7659 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7660 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7661 of the client ranges may be used.
7662
7663 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7664 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7665 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7666 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7667 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7668 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7669 same session.
7670
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007671 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7672 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7673 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007674 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007675
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007676 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7677
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007678 Examples :
7679 backend private
7680 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7681 source 192.168.1.200
7682
7683 backend transparent_ssl1
7684 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7685 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7686
7687 backend transparent_ssl2
7688 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7689 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7690 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7691
7692 backend transparent_ssl3
7693 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7694 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7695 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7696
7697 backend transparent_smtp
7698 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7699 # with Tproxy version 4.
7700 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7701
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007702 backend transparent_http
7703 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7704 # proxy.
7705 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007707 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007708 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007710
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007711srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7712 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7714 yes | no | yes | yes
7715 Arguments :
7716 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7717 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7718 as explained at the top of this document.
7719
7720 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7721 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7722 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7723 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7724 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7725 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7726 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7727
7728 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7729 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7730 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7731 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7732 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007733 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007734 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007735 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007736
7737 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7738 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7739 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7740 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7741 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7742 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7743
7744 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7745 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7746
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007747 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7748 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007749
7750
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007751stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7752 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007754 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007755
7756 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7757 matched.
7758
7759 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7760 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7761
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007762 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7763 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7764 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7765
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007766 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7767 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7768 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7769 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007770
7771 Example :
7772 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7773 backend stats_localhost
7774 stats enable
7775 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7776
7777 Example :
7778 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7779 backend stats_auth
7780 stats enable
7781 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7782 stats admin if TRUE
7783
7784 Example :
7785 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7786 userlist stats-auth
7787 group admin users admin
7788 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7789 group readonly users haproxy
7790 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7791
7792 backend stats_auth
7793 stats enable
7794 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7795 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7796 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7797 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7798
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007799 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7800 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7801 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007802
7803
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007804stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7805 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007807 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007808 Arguments :
7809 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7810
7811 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7812
7813 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7814 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7815 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7816 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7817 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7818 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7819
7820 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7821 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7822 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007823 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007824
7825 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7826 report using "stats scope".
7827
7828 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7829 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7830 unobvious parameters.
7831
7832 Example :
7833 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7834 backend public_www
7835 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7836 stats enable
7837 stats hide-version
7838 stats scope .
7839 stats uri /admin?stats
7840 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7841 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7842 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7843
7844 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7845 backend private_monitoring
7846 stats enable
7847 stats uri /admin?stats
7848 stats refresh 5s
7849
7850 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7851
7852
7853stats enable
7854 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007856 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007857 Arguments : none
7858
7859 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7860 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7861 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7862 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7863 - stats auth : no authentication
7864 - stats scope : no restriction
7865
7866 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7867 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7868 unobvious parameters.
7869
7870 Example :
7871 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7872 backend public_www
7873 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7874 stats enable
7875 stats hide-version
7876 stats scope .
7877 stats uri /admin?stats
7878 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7879 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7880 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7881
7882 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7883 backend private_monitoring
7884 stats enable
7885 stats uri /admin?stats
7886 stats refresh 5s
7887
7888 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7889
7890
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007891stats hide-version
7892 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007894 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007895 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007896
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007897 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7898 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7899 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7900 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7901 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7902 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007903
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007904 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7905 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7906 unobvious parameters.
7907
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007908 Example :
7909 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7910 backend public_www
7911 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007912 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007913 stats hide-version
7914 stats scope .
7915 stats uri /admin?stats
7916 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7917 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7918 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007919
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007920 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7921 backend private_monitoring
7922 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007923 stats uri /admin?stats
7924 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007925
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007926 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007927
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007928
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007929stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7930 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7931 Access control for statistics
7932
7933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7934 no | no | yes | yes
7935
7936 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7937 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7938 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7939 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7940 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7941 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7942
7943 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7944 instance.
7945
7946 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7947 about ACL usage.
7948
7949
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007950stats realm <realm>
7951 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007953 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007954 Arguments :
7955 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7956 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7957 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7958
7959 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7960 using a backslash ('\').
7961
7962 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7963 only related to authentication.
7964
7965 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7966 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7967 unobvious parameters.
7968
7969 Example :
7970 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7971 backend public_www
7972 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7973 stats enable
7974 stats hide-version
7975 stats scope .
7976 stats uri /admin?stats
7977 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7978 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7979 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7980
7981 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7982 backend private_monitoring
7983 stats enable
7984 stats uri /admin?stats
7985 stats refresh 5s
7986
7987 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7988
7989
7990stats refresh <delay>
7991 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007993 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007994 Arguments :
7995 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7996 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7997 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7998 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7999 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8000 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8001
8002 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8003 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8004 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8005 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8006
8007 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8008 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8009 unobvious parameters.
8010
8011 Example :
8012 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8013 backend public_www
8014 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8015 stats enable
8016 stats hide-version
8017 stats scope .
8018 stats uri /admin?stats
8019 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8020 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8021 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8022
8023 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8024 backend private_monitoring
8025 stats enable
8026 stats uri /admin?stats
8027 stats refresh 5s
8028
8029 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8030
8031
8032stats scope { <name> | "." }
8033 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008035 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008036 Arguments :
8037 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8038 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8039 section in which the statement appears.
8040
8041 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8042 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8043 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8044 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8045 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8046 exists.
8047
8048 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8049 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8050 unobvious parameters.
8051
8052 Example :
8053 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8054 backend public_www
8055 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8056 stats enable
8057 stats hide-version
8058 stats scope .
8059 stats uri /admin?stats
8060 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8061 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8062 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8063
8064 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8065 backend private_monitoring
8066 stats enable
8067 stats uri /admin?stats
8068 stats refresh 5s
8069
8070 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8071
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008072
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008073stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008074 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8075 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008076 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008077
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008078 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008079 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8080
8081 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8082 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8083
8084 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8085 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008086 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008087
8088 Example :
8089 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8090 backend private_monitoring
8091 stats enable
8092 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8093 stats uri /admin?stats
8094 stats refresh 5s
8095
8096 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8097 global section.
8098
8099
8100stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008101 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8103 yes | yes | yes | yes
8104 Arguments : none
8105
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008106 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008107 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8108 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8109 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8110 - IP (socket, server)
8111 - cookie (backend, server)
8112
8113 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8114 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008115 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008116
8117 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8118
8119
8120stats show-node [ <name> ]
8121 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008123 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008124 Arguments:
8125 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8126 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8127
8128 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8129 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008130 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008131
8132 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8133 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8134 unobvious parameters.
8135
8136 Example:
8137 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8138 backend private_monitoring
8139 stats enable
8140 stats show-node Europe-1
8141 stats uri /admin?stats
8142 stats refresh 5s
8143
8144 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8145 section.
8146
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008147
8148stats uri <prefix>
8149 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008151 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008152 Arguments :
8153 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8154 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8155 query string.
8156
8157 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8158 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8159 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8160 possible to reach it in the application.
8161
8162 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008163 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008164 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8165 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8166 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8167 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8168
8169 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8170 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8171 an address or a port to statistics only.
8172
8173 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8174 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8175 unobvious parameters.
8176
8177 Example :
8178 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8179 backend public_www
8180 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8181 stats enable
8182 stats hide-version
8183 stats scope .
8184 stats uri /admin?stats
8185 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8186 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8187 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8188
8189 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8190 backend private_monitoring
8191 stats enable
8192 stats uri /admin?stats
8193 stats refresh 5s
8194
8195 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8196
8197
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008198stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8199 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008201 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008202
8203 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008204 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008205 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8206 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8207 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8208
8209 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8210 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8211 the "stick-table" statement.
8212
8213 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8214 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8215 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8216 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8217 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8218
8219 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8220 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8221 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8222 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8223 transformation rules.
8224
8225 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8226 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8227 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8228 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8229 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8230 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8231 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8232
8233 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8234 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8235 ACL based conditions.
8236
8237 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8238 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8239 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8240 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8241
8242 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8243 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8244 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8245 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8246
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008247 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8248 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8249 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8250
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008251 Example :
8252 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8253 # last 30 minutes
8254 backend pop
8255 mode tcp
8256 balance roundrobin
8257 stick store-request src
8258 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8259 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8260 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8261
8262 backend smtp
8263 mode tcp
8264 balance roundrobin
8265 stick match src table pop
8266 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8267 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8268
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008269 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008270 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008271
8272
8273stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8274 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8276 no | no | yes | yes
8277
8278 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8279 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8280 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8281 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8282
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008283 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8284 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8285 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8286
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008287 Examples :
8288 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008289 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008290
8291 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8292 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8293 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8294
8295
8296 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8297 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8298 backend http
8299 mode http
8300 balance roundrobin
8301 stick on src table https
8302 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8303 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8304 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8305
8306 backend https
8307 mode tcp
8308 balance roundrobin
8309 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8310 stick on src
8311 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8312 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8313
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008314 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008315
8316
8317stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8318 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 no | no | yes | yes
8321
8322 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008323 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008324 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8325 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8326 server is selected.
8327
8328 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8329 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8330 the "stick-table" statement.
8331
8332 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8333 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8334 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8335 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8336 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8337 address.
8338
8339 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8340 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8341 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8342 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8343 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8344 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8345 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8346 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8347 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8348 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8349
8350 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8351 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8352 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8353 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8354 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8355 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8356 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8357
8358 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8359 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8360 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8361 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8362
8363 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8364 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8365 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8366 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8367 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8368 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008369 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8370 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8371 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8372 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8373 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8374 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008375
8376 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8377 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8378 the request.
8379
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008380 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8381 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8382 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8383
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008384 Example :
8385 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8386 # last 30 minutes
8387 backend pop
8388 mode tcp
8389 balance roundrobin
8390 stick store-request src
8391 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8392 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8393 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8394
8395 backend smtp
8396 mode tcp
8397 balance roundrobin
8398 stick match src table pop
8399 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8400 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8401
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008402 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008403 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008404
8405
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008406stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008407 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8408 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008409 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008411 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008412
8413 Arguments :
8414 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8415 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8416 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8417 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8418
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008419 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8420 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8421 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8422 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8423
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008424 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8425 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8426 instance.
8427
8428 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8429 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8430 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8431 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8432 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8433 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008434 to 32 characters.
8435
8436 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8437 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8438 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008439 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008440 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8441 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008442
8443 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008444 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8445 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008446 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8447 increase.
8448
8449 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008450 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8451 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8452 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008453
8454 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8455 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8456 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8457 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8458 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8459 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8460 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8461 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8462 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8463 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8464 parameter (see below).
8465
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008466 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8467 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8468 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8469 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8470 soft restart.
8471
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008472 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8473 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008474
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008475 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8476 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8477 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8478 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8479 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008480 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008481 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8482 if not expiration delay is specified.
8483
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008484 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8485 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8486 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8487 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008488 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8489 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8490 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8491 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8492 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8493 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8494 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8495 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8496 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8497 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8498 types and their arguments.
8499
8500 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8501 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8502 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8503 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8504
8505 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8506 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8507 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8508 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8509
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008510 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8511 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8512 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8513 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8514 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8515 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8516
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008517 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8518 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8519 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8520 they were received.
8521
8522 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8523 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8524 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8525 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8526 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8527
8528 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8529 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8530 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8531 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8532 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8533
8534 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8535 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8536 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8537
8538 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8539 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8540 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8541 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8542 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8543
8544 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8545 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8546 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8547 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8548 the client side.
8549
8550 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8551 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8552 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8553 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8554 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8555 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8556 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8557
8558 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8559 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8560 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8561 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8562 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8563 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8564 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8565
8566 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8567 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8568 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8569 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8570 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8571 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8572
8573 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8574 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8575 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8576 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8577
8578 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8579 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8580 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8581 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8582 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8583 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8584 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8585 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8586 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8587 recommended for better fairness.
8588
8589 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8590 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8591 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8592 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8593
8594 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8595 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8596 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8597 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8598 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8599 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8600 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8601 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8602 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8603 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008604
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008605 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8606 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008607 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8608 reference it.
8609
8610 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8611 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008612 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8613 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8614 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008615
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008616 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8617 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8618 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8619 something that can be ignored.
8620
8621 Example:
8622 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8623 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8624 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8625 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8626
8627 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008628 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008629
8630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008631stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008632 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008633 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8634 no | no | yes | yes
8635
8636 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008637 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008638 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8639 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8640 server is selected.
8641
8642 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8643 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8644 the "stick-table" statement.
8645
8646 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8647 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8648 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8649 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8650
8651 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8652 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8653 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8654 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8655 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8656 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008657 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008658 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8659 rules.
8660
8661 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8662 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8663 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8664 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8665 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8666 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8667 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8668
8669 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8670 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8671 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8672 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8673
8674 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8675 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8676 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8677 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8678 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8679 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008680 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8681 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8682 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8683 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8684 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8685 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8686 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8687 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8688 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008689
8690 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8691
8692 Example :
8693 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8694 backend https
8695 mode tcp
8696 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008697 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008698 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008699
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008700 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8701 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8702
8703 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8704 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8705 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8706
8707 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8708 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008709
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008710 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8711 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8712 # at offset 44.
8713
8714 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8715 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8716
8717 # Learn on response if server hello.
8718 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008719
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008720 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8721 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8722
8723 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8724 extraction.
8725
8726
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008727tcp-check connect [params*]
8728 Opens a new connection
8729 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8730 no | no | yes | yes
8731
8732 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8733 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8734 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8735
8736 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8737 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8738 of the sequence.
8739
8740 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8741 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8742 do.
8743
8744 Parameters :
8745 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8746 use the TCP connection.
8747
8748 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8749 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8750 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8751
8752 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8753
8754 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8755
8756 Examples:
8757 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8758 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8759 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8760 option tcp-check
8761 tcp-check connect
8762 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8763 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8764 tcp-check send \r\n
8765 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8766 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8767 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8768 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8769 tcp-check send \r\n
8770 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8771 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8772
8773 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8774 option tcp-check
8775 tcp-check connect port 110
8776 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8777 tcp-check connect port 143
8778 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8779 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8780
8781 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8782
8783
8784tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8785 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8787 no | no | yes | yes
8788
8789 Arguments :
8790 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8791 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8792 binary.
8793 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8794 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8795 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8796
8797 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8798 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8799 with the usual backslash ('\').
8800 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8801 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8802 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8803 used upper or lower case.
8804
8805
8806 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8807
8808 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8809 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8810 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8811 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8812 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8813 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8814 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8815 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8816
8817 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8818 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8819 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8820 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8821 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8822 expression.
8823
8824 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8825 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8826 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8827 this exact hexadecimal string.
8828 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8829
8830 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8831 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8832 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8833 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8834 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8835 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8836 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8837 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8838 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8839 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8840 the null character.
8841
8842 Examples :
8843 # perform a POP check
8844 option tcp-check
8845 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8846
8847 # perform an IMAP check
8848 option tcp-check
8849 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8850
8851 # look for the redis master server
8852 option tcp-check
8853 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008854 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008855 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8856 tcp-check expect string role:master
8857 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8858 tcp-check expect string +OK
8859
8860
8861 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8862 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8863
8864
8865tcp-check send <data>
8866 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8868 no | no | yes | yes
8869
8870 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8871 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8872
8873 Examples :
8874 # look for the redis master server
8875 option tcp-check
8876 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8877 tcp-check expect string role:master
8878
8879 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8880 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8881
8882
8883tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8884 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8885 tcp health check
8886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8887 no | no | yes | yes
8888
8889 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8890 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8891 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8892 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8893 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8894 hexadecimal string.
8895 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8896
8897 Examples :
8898 # redis check in binary
8899 option tcp-check
8900 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8901 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8902
8903
8904 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8905 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8906
8907
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008908tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8909 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8911 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008913 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8914 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008915
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008916 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008917
8918 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8919 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008920 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8921 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8922 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8923 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8924 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8925 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008927 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8928 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8929 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8930 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008931
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008932 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008933 - accept :
8934 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8935 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8936 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008937
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008938 - reject :
8939 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8940 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8941 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8942 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8943 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8944 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8945 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8946 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8947 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8948 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8949 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008950 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008951
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008952 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8953 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8954 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8955 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8956 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8957 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8958 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8959 hosts.
8960
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008961 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8962 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8963 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8964 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8965 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8966 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8967 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8968 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8969
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008970 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8971 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8972 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8973 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8974 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8975 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8976 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8977 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8978 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008979 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8980 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008981
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008982 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008983 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008984 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008985 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008986 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8987 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008988 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008989 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8990 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8991 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8992 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8993 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008995 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008996 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008997 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008998 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8999 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9000 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9001 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009002
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009003 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9004 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9005 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9006 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009007
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009008 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9009 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9010 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9011 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9012 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009013 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9014 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9015 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9016 layer7 information is extracted.
9017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009018 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9019 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9020 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9021 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9022 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009023
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009024 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9025 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9026 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9027 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9028
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009029 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9030 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9031 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9032 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9033 continues.
9034
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009035 - set-src <expr> :
9036 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9037 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9038 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9039 set-src"
9040
9041 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9042 followed by some converters.
9043
9044 Example:
9045
9046 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9047
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009048 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9049 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009050
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009051 - set-src-port <expr> :
9052 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9053 expression.
9054
9055 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9056 followed by some converters.
9057
9058 Example:
9059
9060 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9061
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009062 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9063 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9064 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009065
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009066 - set-dst <expr> :
9067 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9068 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9069 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9070 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9071 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9072
9073 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9074 followed by some converters.
9075
9076 Example:
9077
9078 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9079 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9080
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009081 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9082 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9083
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009084 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9085 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9086 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9087 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9088
9089
9090 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9091 followed by some converters.
9092
9093 Example:
9094
9095 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9096
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009097 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9098 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9099 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9100
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009101 - "silent-drop" :
9102 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9103 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9104 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9105 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9106 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9107 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9108 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9109 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9110 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9111 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9112 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9113 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9114 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9115 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9116 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9117 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9120 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9121 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009123 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9124 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9125 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009126
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009127 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009128 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009129 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009130
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009131 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9132 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9133 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009135 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009136 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9137 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009138
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009139 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9140
9141 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9142
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009143 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9144
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009145 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009146
9147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009148tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9149 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009151 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009152 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009153 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9154 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009156 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009158 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9159 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9160 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9161 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9162 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009164 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9165 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9166 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9167 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009168 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9169 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9170 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9171 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9172 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9173 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009174 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009175 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009177 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9178 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9179 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9180 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009181
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009182 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009183 - accept : the request is accepted
9184 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9185 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009186 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009187 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009188 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009189 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009190 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009191 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009192
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009193 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9194 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009195
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009196 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9197 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9198 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9199 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9200 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9201 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009203 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009204 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9205 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009207 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009208 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9209 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9210 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9211 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009212 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9213 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9214 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009215
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009216 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009217 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9218 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9219 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009220
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009221 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009222 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9223 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009224
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009225 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9226 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009227 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009228 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9229 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009230 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009231 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009232 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009233 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9234 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009236 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9237 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009238
9239 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9240 followed by some converters.
9241
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009242 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9243 <var-name>.
9244
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009245 Example:
9246
9247 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009248 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009249
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009250 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009251 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9252 # and reject everything else.
9253 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9254 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009255 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009256 tcp-request content reject
9257
9258 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009259 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9260 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9261 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009262 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009263
9264 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9265 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9266 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009267 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009268 tcp-request content reject
9269
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009270 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009271 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009272 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009273 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009274 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9275 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009276
9277 Example:
9278 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9279 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009280 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009281
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009282 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009283 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009284
9285 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009286 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009287 # protecting all our sites
9288 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009289 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9290 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009291 ...
9292 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9293
9294 backend http_dynamic
9295 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009296 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009297 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009298 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009299 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009300 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009301 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009303 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009304
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009305 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9306 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009307
9308
9309tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9310 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009312 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009313 Arguments :
9314 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9315 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9316 as explained at the top of this document.
9317
9318 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9319 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9320 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9321 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9322 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9323
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009324 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9325 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9326 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9327 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9328
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009329 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9330 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009331 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009332 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009333 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9334 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9335 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9336 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009337
9338 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9339 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9340 it pass through unaffected.
9341
9342 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9343 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9344 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009345 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009346 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9347 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009348 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9349 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9350 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009351
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009352 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009353 "timeout client".
9354
9355
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009356tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9357 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9359 no | no | yes | yes
9360 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009361 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9362 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009363
9364 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9365
9366 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9367 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9368 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009369 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9370 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009371
9372 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9373
9374 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9375 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9376 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9377 inserted.
9378
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009379 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009380 - accept :
9381 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9382 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9383 the rules evaluation.
9384
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009385 - close :
9386 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9387 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9388 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9389 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9390 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9391 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009392 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009393 protocols.
9394
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009395 - reject :
9396 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9397 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009398 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009399
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009400 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9401 Sets a variable.
9402
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009403 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9404 Unsets a variable.
9405
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009406 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9407 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9408 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9409 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9410
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009411 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9412 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9413 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9414 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9415 continues.
9416
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009417 - "silent-drop" :
9418 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9419 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9420 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9421 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9422 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9423 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9424 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9425 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9426 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9427 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9428 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9429 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9430 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9431 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9432 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9433 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9434
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009435 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9436 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9437 for changing the default action to a reject.
9438
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009439 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9440 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9441 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9442 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009443 period.
9444
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009445 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9446 declared inline.
9447
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009448 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9449 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009450 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009451 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9452 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009453 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009454 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009455 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009456 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9457 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009458 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009459 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9460 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009461
9462 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9463 followed by some converters.
9464
9465 Example:
9466
9467 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9468
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009469 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9470 <var-name>.
9471
9472 Example:
9473
9474 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9475
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009476 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9477
9478 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9479
9480
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009481tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9482 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9484 no | yes | yes | no
9485 Arguments :
9486 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9487 below.
9488
9489 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9490
9491 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9492 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9493 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9494 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9495 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9496 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9497 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9498 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9499 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9500 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9501 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9502 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9503 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9504 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9505 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9506 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9507 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9508 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9509 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9510 instead.
9511
9512 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9513 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9514 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9515 rules which may be inserted.
9516
9517 Several types of actions are supported :
9518 - accept : the request is accepted
9519 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9520 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9521 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9522 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9523 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009524 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009525 - silent-drop
9526
9527 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9528 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9529 sections for a complete description.
9530
9531 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9532 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9533 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9534
9535 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9536 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9537 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9538 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9539 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9540
9541 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9542 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9543
9544 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9545 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9546 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9547
9548 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9549 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9550 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9551
9552 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9553 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9554 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9555
9556 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9557 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9558 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9559
9560 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9561
9562 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9563
9564
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009565tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9566 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9568 no | no | yes | yes
9569 Arguments :
9570 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9571 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9572 as explained at the top of this document.
9573
9574 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9575
9576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009577timeout check <timeout>
9578 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9579 established.
9580
9581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9582 yes | no | yes | yes
9583 Arguments:
9584 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9585 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9586 as explained at the top of this document.
9587
9588 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9589 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9590 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9591 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009592 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9593 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9594 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009595
9596 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9597 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9598
9599 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9600 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009601 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009602
9603 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9604 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9605 forget about it.
9606
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009607 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9608 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009609
9610
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009611timeout client <timeout>
9612timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9613 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | yes | yes | no
9616 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009617 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009618 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9619 as explained at the top of this document.
9620
9621 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9622 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9623 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009624 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9625 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9626 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9627 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009628 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9629 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9630 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009631 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009632 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009633 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9634 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009635 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9636 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009637
9638 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9639 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9640 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9641 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9642 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9643 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9644
9645 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9646 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9647 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9648
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009649 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9650 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009651
9652
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009653timeout client-fin <timeout>
9654 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9656 yes | yes | yes | no
9657 Arguments :
9658 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9659 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9660 as explained at the top of this document.
9661
9662 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9663 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9664 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9665 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9666 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9667 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9668 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9669 down in one direction.
9670
9671 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9672 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9673 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9674
9675 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9676
9677
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009678timeout connect <timeout>
9679timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9680 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9682 yes | no | yes | yes
9683 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009684 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009685 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9686 as explained at the top of this document.
9687
9688 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009689 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009690 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009691 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009692 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9693 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009694
9695 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9696 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9697 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9698 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9699 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9700 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9701
9702 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9703 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9704 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9705
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009706 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9707 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009708
9709
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009710timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9711 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9713 yes | yes | yes | yes
9714 Arguments :
9715 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9716 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9717 as explained at the top of this document.
9718
9719 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9720 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9721 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9722 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9723 once the request has started to present itself.
9724
9725 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9726 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9727 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9728 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9729 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9730
9731 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9732 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9733 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9734 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9735
9736 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9737 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9738 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9739 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9740 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009741 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009742
9743 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9744 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9745 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9746 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9747
9748 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9749
9750
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009751timeout http-request <timeout>
9752 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009754 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009755 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009756 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009757 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9758 as explained at the top of this document.
9759
9760 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9761 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9762 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9763 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9764 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9765 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9766 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009767 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9768 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9769 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9770 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9771 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009772 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9773 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009774
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009775 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9776 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9777 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9778 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9779 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009780 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009781
9782 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9783 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9784 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9785 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9786 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9787
9788 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009789 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9790 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9791 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009792
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009793 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009794 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009795
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009796
9797timeout queue <timeout>
9798 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9800 yes | no | yes | yes
9801 Arguments :
9802 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9803 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9804 as explained at the top of this document.
9805
9806 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9807 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9808 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9809 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9810 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9811
9812 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9813 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9814 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9815 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9816
9817 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9818
9819
9820timeout server <timeout>
9821timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9822 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9824 yes | no | yes | yes
9825 Arguments :
9826 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9827 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9828 as explained at the top of this document.
9829
9830 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9831 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9832 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9833 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9834 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9835 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9836 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9837
9838 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9839 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9840 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9841 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9842 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009843 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009844 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009845 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9846 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9847 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9848 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009849
9850 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9851 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9852 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9853 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9854 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9855 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9856
9857 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9858 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9859 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9860
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009861 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009862
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009863
9864timeout server-fin <timeout>
9865 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9867 yes | no | yes | yes
9868 Arguments :
9869 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9870 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9871 as explained at the top of this document.
9872
9873 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9874 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9875 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9876 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9877 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9878 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9879 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9880 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9881 situations, it should not be needed.
9882
9883 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9884 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9885 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9886
9887 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9888
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009889
9890timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009891 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9893 yes | yes | yes | yes
9894 Arguments :
9895 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9896 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9897 as explained at the top of this document.
9898
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009899 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9900 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9901 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9902 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009903
9904 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9905 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9906 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9907 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009908 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009909
9910 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9911
9912
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009913timeout tunnel <timeout>
9914 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9916 yes | no | yes | yes
9917 Arguments :
9918 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9919 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9920 as explained at the top of this document.
9921
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009922 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009923 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9924 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9925 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9926 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9927 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9928 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9929 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9930 specified.
9931
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009932 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9933 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9934 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9935 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9936 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9937 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9938 state.
9939
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009940 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9941 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9942 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9943 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9944 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9945
9946 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9947 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9948 forget about it.
9949
9950 Example :
9951 defaults http
9952 option http-server-close
9953 timeout connect 5s
9954 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009955 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009956 timeout server 30s
9957 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9958
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009959 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009960
9961
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009962transparent (deprecated)
9963 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009965 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009966 Arguments : none
9967
9968 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9969 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9970 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9971 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9972 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9973 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9974 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9975 appropriate server.
9976
9977 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9978
9979 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9980 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9981
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009982 See also: "option transparent"
9983
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009984unique-id-format <string>
9985 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 yes | yes | yes | no
9988 Arguments :
9989 <string> is a log-format string.
9990
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009991 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9992 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9993 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9994 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009995
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009996 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9997 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9998 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9999 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10000 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10001 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10002 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10003 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010004
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010005 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10006 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010007
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010008 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010009
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010010 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010011
10012 will generate:
10013
10014 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10015
10016 See also: "unique-id-header"
10017
10018unique-id-header <name>
10019 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10021 yes | yes | yes | no
10022 Arguments :
10023 <name> is the name of the header.
10024
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010025 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10026 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010027
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010028 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010029
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010030 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010031 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10032
10033 will generate:
10034
10035 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10036
10037 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010038
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010039use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010040 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10042 no | yes | yes | no
10043 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010044 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10045 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010046
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010047 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10048 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010049
10050 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10051 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10052 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010053 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10054 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10055 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10056 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010057
10058 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10059 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10060 assign the backend.
10061
10062 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10063 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10064 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10065 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10066 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10067 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10068
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010069 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010070 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010071 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10072 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10073 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10074
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010075 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10076 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10077 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10078 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10079 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10080 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10081 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10082 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10083 cannot be forced from the request.
10084
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010085 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010086 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10087 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10088
10089 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10090 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010091
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010092
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010093use-server <server> if <condition>
10094use-server <server> unless <condition>
10095 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10097 no | no | yes | yes
10098 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010099 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010100
10101 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10102
10103 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10104 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10105 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10106
10107 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10108 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10109 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10110 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10111 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10112 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10113 matches will assign the server.
10114
10115 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10116 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10117 with the next rules until one matches.
10118
10119 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10120 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10121 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10122 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10123
10124 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10125 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10126 stripped.
10127
10128 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10129 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10130 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10131 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10132
10133 Example :
10134 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10135 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10136 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10137 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10138 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10139 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010140 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010141 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10142 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10143
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010144 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010145
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010146
101475. Bind and Server options
10148--------------------------
10149
10150The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10151depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10152settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10153written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10154described in this section.
10155
10156
101575.1. Bind options
10158-----------------
10159
10160The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10161as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10162no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10163parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10164while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10165provided immediately after the setting name.
10166
10167The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10168
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010169accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10170 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10171 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10172 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10173 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10174 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10175 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10176 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10177 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10178 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010179 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10180 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10181 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010182
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010183accept-proxy
10184 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010185 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10186 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010187 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10188 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10189 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10190 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10191 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10192 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10193 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010194 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10195 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010196
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010197alpn <protocols>
10198 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10199 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10200 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10201 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10202 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10203 initial NPN extension.
10204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010205backlog <backlog>
10206 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10207 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10208
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010209curves <curves>
10210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10211 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10212 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10213 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10214 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10215 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10216
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010217ecdhe <named curve>
10218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010219 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10220 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010221
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010222ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010223 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10224 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10225 client's certificate.
10226
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010227ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10228 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10229 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10230 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10231 error is ignored.
10232
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010233ca-sign-file <cafile>
10234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10235 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10236 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10237 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10238 'generate-certificates' for details.
10239
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010240ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10242 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10243 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10244 'generate-certificates' for details.
10245
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010246ciphers <ciphers>
10247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10248 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010249 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010250 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10251 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10252
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010253crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010254 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10255 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10256 to verify client's certificate.
10257
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010258crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10260 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10261 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10262 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10263 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10264 file.
10265
10266 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10267 are loaded.
10268
10269 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010270 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010271 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10272 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10273 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10274 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10275 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10276 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10277 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010278
10279 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10280 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10281 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10282 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010283 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10284 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010285
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010286 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010287
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010288 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10289 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010290 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010291 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10292 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10293 clients).
10294
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010295 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10296 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10297 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10298 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10299 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10300 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10301 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10302 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10303 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10304 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10305 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10306 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10307 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10308
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010309 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10310 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10311 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10312 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10313 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10314
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010315 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10316 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10317 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10318 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010319
10320 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10321 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10322 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10323 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10324 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10325 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10326 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10327 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10328 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10329
10330 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10331
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010332 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010333 a cert bundle.
10334
10335 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10336 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10337 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10338 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10339 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10340 provide multi-cert support.
10341
10342 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10343
10344 Filename | CN | SAN
10345 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10346 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010347 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010348 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10349 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10350
10351 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10352 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10353 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10354 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010355 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10356 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010357
10358 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10359 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10360
10361 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10362 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10363 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10364
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010365crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10367 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010368 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010369 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010370
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010371crt-list <file>
10372 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010373 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10374 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010375
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010376 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10377
10378 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010379 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010380 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010381
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010382 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10383 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10384 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10385 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10386 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10387 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10388 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10389 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010390
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010391 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010392 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010393 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10394 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10395 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010396
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010397 crt-list file example:
10398 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010399 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010400 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010401 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010402
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010403defer-accept
10404 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10405 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10406 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10407 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10408 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10409 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10410 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10411 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10412 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10413 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10414 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10415
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010416force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010417 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010418 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010419 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10420 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010421
10422force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010423 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010424 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10425 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010426
10427force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010428 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010429 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10430 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010431
10432force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010433 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010434 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10435 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010436
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010437generate-certificates
10438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10439 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10440 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10441 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10442 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10443 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10444 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10445 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10446 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10447 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10448 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10449
10450 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10451 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10452 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10453 certificate is used many times.
10454
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010455gid <gid>
10456 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10457 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10458 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10459 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10460 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10461
10462group <group>
10463 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10464 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10465 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10466 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10467 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10468
10469id <id>
10470 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10471 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10472 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10473 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10474
10475interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010476 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10477 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10478 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10479 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10480 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10481 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10482 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010483
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010484level <level>
10485 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10486 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10487 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10488 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10489 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10490 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10491 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10492 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10493 counters).
10494 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10495 all counters).
10496
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010497maxconn <maxconn>
10498 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10499 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10500 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10501 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10502 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10503 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10504 eat all memory.
10505
10506mode <mode>
10507 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10508 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10509 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10510 UNIX sockets.
10511
10512mss <maxseg>
10513 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10514 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10515 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10516 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10517 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10518 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10519 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10520 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10521 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10522 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10523 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10524
10525name <name>
10526 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10527 page.
10528
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010529namespace <name>
10530 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10531 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10532 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10533 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10534
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010535nice <nice>
10536 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10537 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10538 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10539 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10540 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10541 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10542 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10543 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10544 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10545 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10546 one for an RDP socket.
10547
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010548no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010549 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010550 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010551 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010552 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10553 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010554 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010555
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010556no-tls-tickets
10557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10558 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10559 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010560 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10561 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010562
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010563no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010564 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010565 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010566 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010567 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10568 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10569 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010570
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010571no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010573 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010574 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010575 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10576 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10577 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010578
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010579no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010581 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010582 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010583 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10584 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10585 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010586
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010587npn <protocols>
10588 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10589 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10590 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10591 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010592 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10593 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010594
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010595process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10596 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10597 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10598 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10599 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10600 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10601 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10602 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010603 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10604 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10605 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10606 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10607 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10608 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10609 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010610
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010611ssl
10612 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010613 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010614 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10615 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10616 to deciphered contents.
10617
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010618strict-sni
10619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10620 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10621 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10622 See the "crt" option for more information.
10623
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010624tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010625 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010626 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10627 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010628 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010629 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10630 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10631 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10632 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10633 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10634 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10635 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10636
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010637tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010638 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010639 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10640 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10641 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10642 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10643 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10644 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10645 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010646 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10647 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10648 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010649
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010650tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10651 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10652 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10653 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10654 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10655 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10656 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10657 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10658 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10659 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10660 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10661
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010662transparent
10663 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10664 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10665 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10666 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10667 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10668 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10669 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10670 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10671 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10672 so check for support with your vendor.
10673
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010674v4v6
10675 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10676 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10677 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10678 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010679 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010680
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010681v6only
10682 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10683 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10684 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010685 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10686 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010688uid <uid>
10689 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10690 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10691 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10692 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10693 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10694
10695user <user>
10696 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10697 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10698 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10699 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10700 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10701
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010702verify [none|optional|required]
10703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10704 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10705 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10706 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10707 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010708 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10709 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10710 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10711 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010712
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200107135.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010714------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010716The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10717which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10718arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10719settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10720after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10721Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10722address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010724 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010725 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010726
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010727Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10728keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010730The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010731
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010732addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010733 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010734 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10735 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10736 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10737 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10738 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010739
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010740agent-check
10741 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010742 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10743 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10744 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10745 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010746
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010747 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010748 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010749 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10750 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10751 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010752
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010753 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10754 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10755 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10756 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10757 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10758
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010759 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10760 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010761
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010762 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10763 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10764 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010765
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010766 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10767 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10768 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010769
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010770 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10771 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10772 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10773 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10774 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10775 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10776 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010777
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010778 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10779 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010780
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010781 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10782 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10783 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10784 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10785 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10786 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10787 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10788 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10789 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010790
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010791 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10792 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010793 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10794 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10795 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010796 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010797
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010798 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010799 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010800
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010801agent-send <string>
10802 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10803 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10804 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10805 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10806 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10807
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010808agent-inter <delay>
10809 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10810 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10811
10812 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10813 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10814 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10815 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10816 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10817 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10818 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10819 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10820 of backends use the same servers.
10821
10822 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10823
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010824agent-addr <addr>
10825 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10826
10827 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10828 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10829 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10830 hostname, it will be resolved.
10831
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010832agent-port <port>
10833 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10834
10835 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010837backup
10838 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10839 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10840 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10841 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010842 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10843 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010844
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010845ca-file <cafile>
10846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10847 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10848 server's certificate.
10849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010850check
10851 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010852 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10853 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10854 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10855 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10856 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10857 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10858 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010859 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10860 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010861 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10862 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010863
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010864check-send-proxy
10865 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10866 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10867 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10868 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10869 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10870 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10871 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10872
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010873check-ssl
10874 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10875 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10876 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10877 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010878 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010879 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10880 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10881 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010882 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10883 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010884
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010885ciphers <ciphers>
10886 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010887 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010888 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10889 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10890 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10891 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10892 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10893 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010895cookie <value>
10896 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10897 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10898 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10899 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10900 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10901 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10902 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10903
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010904crl-file <crlfile>
10905 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10906 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10907 to verify server's certificate.
10908
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010909crt <cert>
10910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10911 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10912 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10913 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10914 certificate request.
10915
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010916disabled
10917 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10918 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10919 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10920 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10921 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010922 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010923
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010924enabled
10925 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10926 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10927 default value.
10928 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10929 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010931error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010932 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10933 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10934 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010935
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010936 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010937
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010938fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010939 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10940 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10941 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10942
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010943force-sslv3
10944 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10945 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010946 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010947 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-sslv3", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010948
10949force-tlsv10
10950 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010951 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010952 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv10", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010953
10954force-tlsv11
10955 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010956 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010957 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv11", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010958
10959force-tlsv12
10960 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010961 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010962 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv12", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010963
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010965 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10966 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10967 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010968
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010969init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10970 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10971 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10972 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10973 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10974 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10975 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10976 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10977 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10978 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10979 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10980 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10981 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10982 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10983 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10984 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10985 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10986 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10987 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10988 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10989 historic behaviour.
10990
10991 Example:
10992 defaults
10993 # never fail on address resolution
10994 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10995
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010996inter <delay>
10997fastinter <delay>
10998downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010999 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11000 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11001 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11002 between checks depending on the server state :
11003
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011004 Server state | Interval used
11005 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11006 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11007 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11008 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11009 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11010 or yet unchecked. |
11011 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11012 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11013 | "inter" otherwise.
11014 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011016 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11017 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11018 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11019 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011020 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11021 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11022 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11023 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11024 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011025
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011026maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011027 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11028 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11029 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11030 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11031 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11032 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11033 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11034 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11035
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011036maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011037 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11038 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11039 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11040 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11041 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11042 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11043 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011045minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011046 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11047 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11048 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11049 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11050 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11051 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011052 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011053 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011054
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011055namespace <name>
11056 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11057 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11058 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11059 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11060
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011061no-agent-check
11062 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11063 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11064 default value.
11065 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11066 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11067
11068no-backup
11069 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11070 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11071 default value.
11072 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11073 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11074
11075no-check
11076 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11077 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11078 default value.
11079 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11080 "default-server" "check" setting.
11081
11082no-check-ssl
11083 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11084 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11085 default value.
11086 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11087 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11088
11089no-force-sslv3
11090 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-sslv3"
11091 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11092 default value.
11093 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11094 "default-server" "force-sslv3" setting.
11095
11096no-force-tlsv10
11097 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv10"
11098 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11099 default value.
11100 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11101 "default-server" "force-tlsv10" setting.
11102
11103no-force-tlsv11
11104 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv11"
11105 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11106 default value.
11107 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11108 "default-server" "force-tlsv11" setting.
11109
11110no-force-tlsv12
11111 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv12"
11112 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11113 default value.
11114 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11115 "default-server" "force-tlsv12" setting.
11116
11117no-send-proxy
11118 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11119 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11120 default value.
11121 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11122 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11123
11124no-send-proxy-v2
11125 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11126 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11127 default value.
11128 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11129 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11130
11131no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11132 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11133 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11134 default value.
11135 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11136 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11137
11138no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11139 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11140 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11141 default value.
11142 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11143 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11144
11145no-ssl
11146 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11147 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11148 default value.
11149 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11150 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11151
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011152no-ssl-reuse
11153 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11154 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11155 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11156 and for paranoid users.
11157
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011158no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011159 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11160 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011161 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011162
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011163no-tls-tickets
11164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11165 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11166 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011167 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11168 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011169 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011170
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011171no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011172 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011173 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11174 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011175 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11176 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011177 See also "tlsv10", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011178
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011179no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011180 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011181 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11182 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011183 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11184 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011185 See also "tlsv11", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011186
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011187no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011188 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011189 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11190 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011191 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11192 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011193 See also "tlsv12", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011194
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011195no-verifyhost
11196 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11197 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11198 default value.
11199 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11200 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011201
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011202non-stick
11203 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11204 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11205 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011207observe <mode>
11208 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11209 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11210 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11211 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11212 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11213 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011214 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011215
11216 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11217
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011218on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011219 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11220 Currently, four modes are available:
11221 - fastinter: force fastinter
11222 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11223 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11224 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11225 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11226
11227 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11228
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011229on-marked-down <action>
11230 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11231 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011232 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11233 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11234 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11235 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11236 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11237 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11238 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11239 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011240
11241 Actions are disabled by default
11242
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011243on-marked-up <action>
11244 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11245 Currently one action is available:
11246 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11247 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11248 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11249 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11250 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11251 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11252 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11253 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11254
11255 Actions are disabled by default
11256
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011257port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011258 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11259 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11260 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11261 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11262 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11263 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11264
11265redir <prefix>
11266 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11267 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11268 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11269 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11270 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11271 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11272 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11273 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011274 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011275 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11276 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11277 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11278 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11279 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11280
11281 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011283rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011284 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11285 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11286 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11287
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011288resolve-prefer <family>
11289 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11290 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11291 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11292 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11293
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011294 Default value: ipv6
11295
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011296 Example:
11297
11298 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011299
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011300resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11301 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11302 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011303 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011304 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11305 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11306 configured network, another address is selected.
11307
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011308 Example:
11309
11310 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011311
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011312resolvers <id>
11313 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11314 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011315 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11316 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11317 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11318 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011319
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011320 Example:
11321
11322 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011323
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011324 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011325
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011326send-proxy
11327 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11328 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11329 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11330 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011331 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11332 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11333 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11334 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11335 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11336 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11337 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11338 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11339 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11340 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011341 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11342 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011343
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011344send-proxy-v2
11345 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11346 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11347 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11348 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11349 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011350 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11351 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11352 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011353
11354send-proxy-v2-ssl
11355 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11356 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11357 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11358 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11359 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11360 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11361 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011362 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11363 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011364
11365send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11366 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11367 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11368 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11369 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11370 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11371 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11372 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11373 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011374 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11375 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011377slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011378 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11379 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11380 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11381 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11382 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11383 parameters :
11384
11385 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11386 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11387
11388 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11389 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11390 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11391 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11392
11393 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11394 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11395 seen as failed.
11396
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011397sni <expression>
11398 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11399 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11400 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11401 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11402 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11403
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011404source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011405source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011406source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011407 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11408 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11409 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11410 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11411
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011412 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11413 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11414 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11415 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11416 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11417 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11418 server.
11419
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011420 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11421 specifying the source address without port(s).
11422
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011423ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011424 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11425 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11426 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11427 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11428 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11429 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011430 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11431 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011432
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011433sslv3
11434 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-sslv3"
11435 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11436 default value.
11437 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11438 "default-server" "no-sslv3" setting.
11439
11440ssl-reuse
11441 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11442 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11443 default value.
11444 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11445 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11446
11447stick
11448 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11449 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11450 default value.
11451 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11452 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011453
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011454tcp-ut <delay>
11455 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11456 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11457 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011458 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011459 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11460 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11461 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11462 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11463 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11464 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11465 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11466 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11467 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11468
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011469track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011470 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11471 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11472 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11473 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011474 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11475
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011476tlsv10
11477 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv10"
11478 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11479 default value.
11480 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11481 "default-server" "no-tlsv10" setting.
11482
11483tlsv11
11484 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv11"
11485 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11486 default value.
11487 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11488 "default-server" "no-tlsv11" setting.
11489
11490tlsv12
11491 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv12"
11492 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11493 default value.
11494 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11495 "default-server" "no-tlsv12" setting.
11496
11497tls-tickets
11498 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11499 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11500 default value.
11501 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11502 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011503
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011504verify [none|required]
11505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011506 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11507 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11508 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11509 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011510 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11511 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11512 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011513
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011514verifyhost <hostname>
11515 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11516 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11517 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11518 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11519 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11520 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011521 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011522
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011523weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011524 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11525 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11526 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011527 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11528 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11529 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11530 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11531 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11532 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011533
11534
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115355.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11536-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011537
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011538HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11539using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11540configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011541This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11542can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11543workload.
11544This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11545resolution at run time.
11546Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11547carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11548
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011549Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11550health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11551
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011552
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115535.3.1. Global overview
11554----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011555
11556As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11557different steps of the process life:
11558
11559 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11560 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11561 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11562
11563 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11564 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11565 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11566
11567A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11568 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11569 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11570 resolution to know this new IP.
11571
11572A few things important to notice:
11573 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11574 first valid response.
11575
11576 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11577 servers return an error.
11578
11579
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115805.3.2. The resolvers section
11581----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011582
11583This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11584HAProxy.
11585There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11586many name servers.
11587
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011588When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11589uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11590is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11591answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11592
11593When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11594used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11595
11596Two types of behavior can be applied:
11597 1. stop DNS resolution
11598 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11599 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11600 1. ANY query type
11601 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11602 server's parameter
11603 3. remaining family type
11604
11605HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11606 - invalid DNS response packet
11607 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11608 - NX domain
11609 - Query refused by server
11610 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11611
11612HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11613 - no Answer records in the response
11614 - DNS response truncated
11615 - Error in DNS response
11616 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11617 - name server timeout
11618
11619For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11620 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11621 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11622 applied;
11623 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11624 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11625 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11626 stops resolution.
11627
11628
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011629resolvers <resolvers id>
11630 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11631
11632A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11633
11634nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11635 DNS server description:
11636 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11637 <ip> : IP address of the server
11638 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11639
11640hold <status> <period>
11641 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11642 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011643 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11644 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011645 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11646 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11647 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11648
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011649 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011650
11651 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11652 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11653 the healch check.
11654
11655resolve_retries <nb>
11656 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11657 giving up.
11658 Default value: 3
11659
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011660 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11661 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11662 type.
11663
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011664timeout <event> <time>
11665 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11666 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11667 events available are:
11668 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11669 been received.
11670 Default value: 1s
11671 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11672 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11673
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011674 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011675
11676 resolvers mydns
11677 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11678 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11679 resolve_retries 3
11680 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011681 hold other 30s
11682 hold refused 30s
11683 hold nx 30s
11684 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011685 hold valid 10s
11686
11687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116886. HTTP header manipulation
11689---------------------------
11690
11691In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11692response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11693request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11694which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011695against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011696
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011697If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11698to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11699but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11700HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11701stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11702because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11703a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11704still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011705
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011706This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11707in section 4.2 :
11708
11709 - reqadd <string>
11710 - reqallow <search>
11711 - reqiallow <search>
11712 - reqdel <search>
11713 - reqidel <search>
11714 - reqdeny <search>
11715 - reqideny <search>
11716 - reqpass <search>
11717 - reqipass <search>
11718 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11719 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11720 - reqtarpit <search>
11721 - reqitarpit <search>
11722 - rspadd <string>
11723 - rspdel <search>
11724 - rspidel <search>
11725 - rspdeny <search>
11726 - rspideny <search>
11727 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11728 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11729
11730With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11731is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11732parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11733prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11734Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11735
11736 \t for a tab
11737 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11738 \n for a new line (LF)
11739 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11740 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11741 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11742 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11743 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11744
11745The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11746portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11747above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11748regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
117499 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11750is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11751
11752The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11753after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11754
11755Notes related to these keywords :
11756---------------------------------
11757 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11758 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11759 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11760
11761 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11762 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11763 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11764
11765 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11766 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11767 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11768 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11769 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11770
11771 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11772 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11773 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11774 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11775 useless headers before adding new ones.
11776
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011777 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011778 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11779
11780 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11781 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11782 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11783
11784 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11785 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011786 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011787
11788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117897. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11790----------------------------------
11791
11792Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11793client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11794The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11795these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11796but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11797data called patterns.
11798
11799
118007.1. ACL basics
11801---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011802
11803The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11804content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11805from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11806simple :
11807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011808 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011809 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011810 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11811 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011813The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11814adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011815
11816In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011818 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011819
11820This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11821Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11822and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011823an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11824conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11825as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11826are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011827
11828ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11829'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11830which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11831
11832There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11833performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011835The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11836specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11837this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011838methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11839ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011840
11841Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11842 - boolean
11843 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11844 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11845 - string
11846 - data block
11847
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011848Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11849converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11850would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11851The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11852which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11853
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011854Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11855keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11856fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11857which are summarized in the table below :
11858
11859 +---------------------+-----------------+
11860 | Sample or converter | Default |
11861 | output type | matching method |
11862 +---------------------+-----------------+
11863 | boolean | bool |
11864 +---------------------+-----------------+
11865 | integer | int |
11866 +---------------------+-----------------+
11867 | ip | ip |
11868 +---------------------+-----------------+
11869 | string | str |
11870 +---------------------+-----------------+
11871 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11872 +---------------------+-----------------+
11873
11874Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11875matching method, see below.
11876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011877The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11878 - boolean
11879 - integer or integer range
11880 - IP address / network
11881 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11882 - regular expression
11883 - hex block
11884
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011885The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11886
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011887 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11888 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011889 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011890 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011891 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011892 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011893 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011895The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11896read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11897if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11898lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11899will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11900beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11901a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11902lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11903exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11904
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011905The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11906parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11907ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11908a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11909check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11910
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011911The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11912socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11913file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011915Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11916loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11917
11918 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11919
11920In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11921the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11922case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11923as well.
11924
11925The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11926sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11927do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11928methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11929is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11930obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11931followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11932default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11933that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11934string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11935
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011936The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11937By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11938string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11939resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11940server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11941waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11942flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11943function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11944
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011945There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11946sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11947be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011948
11949 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11950 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011951 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11952 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11953 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11954 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011955
11956 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11957 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011958 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011959
11960 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011962
11963 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011964 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011965
11966 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11967 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11968
11969 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11970 binary or string samples.
11971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011972 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11973 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011975 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11976 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11977 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011979 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11980 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011982 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11983 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011985 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11986 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011988 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11989 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011990 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11993 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11994 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011995
11996For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11997request, it is possible to do :
11998
11999 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12000
12001In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12002buffer, one would use the following acl :
12003
12004 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12005
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012006On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12007possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12008
12009 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012011All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12012criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12013method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12014to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12015criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12016the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012018If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012019the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12020For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012022 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12023 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12024 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12025 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012026
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012027
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012028The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12029types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12030combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12031brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12032default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012034 +-------------------------------------------------+
12035 | Input sample type |
12036 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012037 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012038 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12039 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12040 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012041 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012042 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012043 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012044 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012045 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012046 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012047 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012048 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012049 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012050 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012051 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012052 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012053 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012054 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012055 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012056 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012057 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012058 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012059 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012060 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012061 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012062 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12063 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12064 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012065
12066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120677.1.1. Matching booleans
12068------------------------
12069
12070In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12071Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12072When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12073that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12074
12075Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12076return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12077"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12078
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120807.1.2. Matching integers
12081------------------------
12082
12083Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12084enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12085to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12086
12087Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12088matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12089lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012090
12091For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12092unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12093representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12094
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012095As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12096two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12097instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12098ranges and operators.
12099
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012100For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012101operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12102Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12103of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012104
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012105Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012106
12107 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12108 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12109 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12110 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12111 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12112
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012113For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012114
12115 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12116
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012117This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12118
12119 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121227.1.3. Matching strings
12123-----------------------
12124
12125String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12126different forms :
12127
12128 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12129 patterns ;
12130
12131 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12132 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12133
12134 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12135 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12136
12137 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12138 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12139
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012140 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012141 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12142 matches.
12143
12144 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12145 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12146 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012147
12148String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12149exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12150characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12151string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12152to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012153before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012154
12155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121567.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12157---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012158
12159Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12160they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12161possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12162passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12163the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012164the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12165match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012166
12167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12169-------------------------------------
12170
12171It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12172not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12173a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12174to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12175digits may be used upper or lower case.
12176
12177Example :
12178 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12179 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12180
12181
121827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12183---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012184
12185IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12186netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12187within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012188host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012189difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12190at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12191does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12192parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012193
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012194The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12195abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12196
12197 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12198 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12199 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12200 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12201 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12202 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12203 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12204 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12205
12206Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12207192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12208
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012209IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12210Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12211trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12212IPv6 patterns.
12213
12214HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12215following situations :
12216 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12217 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12218 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12219 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12220 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12221 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12222 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12223 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12224 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12225 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012227
122287.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12229----------------------------------
12230
12231Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12232combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12233
12234 - AND (implicit)
12235 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12236 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012238A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012240 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012242Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12243indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12246"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12247requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12248is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12249
12250 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012251 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12252 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12253 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012254
12255To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12256and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12257
12258 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12259 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12260 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12261 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12262
12263 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12264 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12265 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12266 use_backend www if host_www
12267
12268It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12269expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12270be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12271the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12272
12273 The following rule :
12274
12275 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012276 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012277
12278 Can also be written that way :
12279
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012280 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012281
12282It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12283to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12284simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12285sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12286good use is the following :
12287
12288 With named ACLs :
12289
12290 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12291 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12292 monitor fail if site_dead
12293
12294 With anonymous ACLs :
12295
12296 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12297
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012298See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12299keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012300
12301
123027.3. Fetching samples
12303---------------------
12304
12305Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12306against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12307sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12308ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12309of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12310available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12311
12312This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12313Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12314compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12315deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12316
12317The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12318matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12319method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12320indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12321
12322As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12323when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12324mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12325the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12326ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12327
12328Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12329multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12330when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12331incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12332are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12333is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12334all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12335
12336Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12337 - name
12338 - name(arg1)
12339 - name(arg1,arg2)
12340
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012341
123427.3.1. Converters
12343-----------------
12344
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012345Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12346of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12347is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12348was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12349has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12350unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12351
12352These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12353sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12354the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12355support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012356
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012357A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12358support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12359supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12360(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12361bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012363The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012364
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001236551d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12366 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12367 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12368 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12369 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12370 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12371
12372 Example :
12373 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12374 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12375 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12376 frontend http-in
12377 bind *:8081
12378 default_backend servers
12379 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12380 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12381
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012382add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012383 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012384 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012385 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12386 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012387 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012388 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12389 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12390 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12391 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12392 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012393 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012394
12395and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012396 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012397 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012398 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12399 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012400 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012401 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12402 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12403 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12404 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12405 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012406 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012407
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012408base64
12409 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12410 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12411 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12412
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012413bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012414 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012415 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12416 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12417 presence of a flag).
12418
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012419bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12420 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12421 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012422 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012423
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012424cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012425 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12426 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012427
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012428crc32([<avalanche>])
12429 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12430 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12431 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12432 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12433 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12434 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12435 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12436 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12437 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12438 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12439 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12440
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012441da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012442 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12443 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12444 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12445 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012446 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012447 configuration language.
12448
12449 Example:
12450 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012451 bind *:8881
12452 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012453 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012454
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012455debug
12456 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12457 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12458 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12459
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012460div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012461 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12462 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012463 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012464 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12465 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012466 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012467 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12468 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12469 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12470 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12471 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012472 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012473
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012474djb2([<avalanche>])
12475 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12476 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12477 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12478 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12479 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12480 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12481 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012482 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12483 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012484
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012485even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012486 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012487 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12488
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012489field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12490 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12491 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12492 list of chars.
12493
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012494hex
12495 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12496 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12497 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12498 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012499
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012500http_date([<offset>])
12501 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12502 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12503 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12504 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12505 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12506 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012507
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012508in_table(<table>)
12509 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12510 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12511 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12512 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12513 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12514
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012515ipmask(<mask>)
12516 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12517 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12518 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12519 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12520
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012521json([<input-code>])
12522 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12523 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012524 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012525 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12526 of errors:
12527 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12528 bytes, ...)
12529 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12530 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12531
12532 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12533 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12534 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12535 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12536 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12537 are :
12538 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12539 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12540 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12541 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12542 error ;
12543 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12544 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12545
12546 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12547 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12548
12549 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012550 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012551 capture request header user-agent len 150
12552 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012553
12554 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12555 GET / HTTP/1.0
12556 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12557
12558 Output log:
12559 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12560
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012561language(<value>[,<default>])
12562 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12563 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12564 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12565 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12566 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12567 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12568 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12569 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12570 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12571 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12572 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12573 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012574
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012575 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012576
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012577 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12578 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012579
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012580 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12581 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12582 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12583 use_backend spanish if es
12584 use_backend french if fr
12585 use_backend english if en
12586 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012587
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012588lower
12589 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12590 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12591 type. The result is of type string.
12592
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012593ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12594 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12595 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12596 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12597 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12598 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12599 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12600
12601 Example :
12602
12603 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12604 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12605 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012607map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12608map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12609map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12610 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12611 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12612 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12613 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12614 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12615 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12616 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12617 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012619 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12620 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12621 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012622
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012623 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012624 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012626 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12627 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12628 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12629 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012630 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12631 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012632 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12633 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12634 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12635 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12636 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12637 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12638 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12639 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012640 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12641 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12642 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012643 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12644 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12645 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12646 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12647 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012648
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012649 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12650 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12651 the corresponding match text.
12652
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012653 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12654 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12655 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12656 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12657 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012658
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012659 Example :
12660
12661 # this is a comment and is ignored
12662 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12663 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12664 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12665 | | | `---------- value
12666 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12667 | `---------------------------- key
12668 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12669
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012670mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012671 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12672 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012673 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012674 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012675 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012676 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12677 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12678 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12679 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12680 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012681 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012682
12683mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012684 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012685 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12686 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012687 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012688 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012689 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012690 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12691 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12692 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12693 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12694 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012695 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012696
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012697nbsrv
12698 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12699 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12700 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12701 map lookup.
12702
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012703neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012704 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12705 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12706 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12707 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012708
12709not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012710 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012711 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12712 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12713 absence of a flag).
12714
12715odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012716 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012717 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12718
12719or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012720 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012721 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012722 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12723 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012724 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012725 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12726 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12727 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12728 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12729 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012730 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012731
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012732regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012733 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12734 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12735 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12736 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12737 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12738 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12739 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12740 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12741 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12742 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012743 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12744 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12745 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12746 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012747
12748 Example :
12749
12750 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12751 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12752 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12753 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12754
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012755capture-req(<id>)
12756 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12757 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12758
12759 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012760 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12761 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012762
12763capture-res(<id>)
12764 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12765 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12766
12767 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012768 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12769 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012770
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012771sdbm([<avalanche>])
12772 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12773 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12774 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12775 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12776 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12777 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12778 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012779 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12780 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012781
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012782set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012783 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12784 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12785 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012786 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012787 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12788 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012789 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012790 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12791 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012792 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012793 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012794
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012795sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012796 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12797 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012798 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012799 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12800 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012801 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012802 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12803 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012804 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012805 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12806 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012807 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012808 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012809
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012810table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12811 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12812 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12813 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12814 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12815 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12816 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12817
12818
12819table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12820 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12821 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12822 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12823 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12824 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12825 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12826
12827table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12830 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12831 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12832 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12833
12834table_conn_cur(<table>)
12835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12838 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12839 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12840
12841table_conn_rate(<table>)
12842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12845 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12846 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12847
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012848table_gpt0(<table>)
12849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12852 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12853 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12854
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012855table_gpc0(<table>)
12856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12859 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12860 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12861
12862table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12863 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12864 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12865 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12866 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12867 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12868 sample fetch keyword.
12869
12870table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12871 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12872 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12873 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12874 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12875 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12876
12877table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12878 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12879 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12880 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12881 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12882 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12883 keyword.
12884
12885table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12886 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12887 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12888 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12889 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12890 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12891
12892table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12895 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12896 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12897 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12898 keyword.
12899
12900table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12904 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12905 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12906 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12907 keyword.
12908
12909table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12913 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12914 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12915 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12916 keyword.
12917
12918table_server_id(<table>)
12919 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12920 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12921 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12922 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12923 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12924 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12925
12926table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12927 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12928 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12929 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12930 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12931 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12932 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12933 keyword.
12934
12935table_sess_rate(<table>)
12936 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12937 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12938 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12939 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12940 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12941 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12942 keyword.
12943
12944table_trackers(<table>)
12945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12948 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12949 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12950 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12951 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12952 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12953 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12954 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12955
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012956upper
12957 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12958 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12959 type. The result is of type string.
12960
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012961url_dec
12962 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12963 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12964
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012965unset-var(<var name>)
12966 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12967 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12968 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12971 response),
12972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12973 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12974 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12975 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12976
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012977utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12978 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12979 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12980 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12981 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12982 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12983 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12984
12985 Example :
12986
12987 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12988 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12989 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12990
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012991word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12992 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12993 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12994
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012995wt6([<avalanche>])
12996 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12997 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12998 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12999 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13000 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13001 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13002 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013003 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13004 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013005
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013006xor(<value>)
13007 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013008 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013009 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013010 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013011 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013012 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13013 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013014 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013015 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13016 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013017 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013018 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013019
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013020xxh32([<seed>])
13021 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13022 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13023 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13024 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13025 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13026 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13027 as cryptographically secure.
13028
13029xxh64([<seed>])
13030 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13031 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13032 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13033 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13034 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13035 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13036 as cryptographically secure.
13037
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013038
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130397.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013040--------------------------------------------
13041
13042A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13043not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13044"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13045The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13046
13047always_false : boolean
13048 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13049 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13050
13051always_true : boolean
13052 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13053 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13054
13055avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013056 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13058 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13059 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13060 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13061 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13062 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13063 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13064 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13065 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13066 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13067 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13068 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13069 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013071be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013072 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13073 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13074 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13075 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13076 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013078be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13079 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13080 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13081 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13082 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13083 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13084 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013085
13086 Example :
13087 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13088 backend dynamic
13089 mode http
13090 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13091 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013092
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013093bin(<hexa>) : bin
13094 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13095 of the string.
13096
13097bool(<bool>) : bool
13098 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13099 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13102 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013103 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013104 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13105 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013106
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013107 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013108 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013109 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13110
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013111 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13112 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013113
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013114 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013115 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013117 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13118 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013119 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013120 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013121
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013122 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13123 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013124 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013125 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013126
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013127date([<offset>]) : integer
13128 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13129 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13130 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13131 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013132 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13133
13134 Example :
13135
13136 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13137 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013138
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013139env(<name>) : string
13140 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13141 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13142 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13143 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13144 certain way.
13145
13146 Examples :
13147 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13148 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13149
13150 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13151 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013153fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13154 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013155 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13156 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013157 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13158 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13159 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13160 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13161 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013162
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013163fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13165 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13166 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013168fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13169 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13170 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13171 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13172 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13173 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13174 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13175 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13176 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013177
13178 Example :
13179 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13180 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13181 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13182 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13183 frontend mail
13184 bind :25
13185 mode tcp
13186 maxconn 100
13187 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13188 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13189 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13190 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013191
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013192hostname : string
13193 Returns the system hostname.
13194
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013195int(<integer>) : signed integer
13196 Returns a signed integer.
13197
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013198ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13199 Returns an ipv4.
13200
13201ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13202 Returns an ipv6.
13203
13204meth(<method>) : method
13205 Returns a method.
13206
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013207nbproc : integer
13208 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13209 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13210 and debugging purposes.
13211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13213 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13214 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13215 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013216 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13217 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13218 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013219
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013220proc : integer
13221 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13222 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13223 debugging purposes.
13224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013225queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013226 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13227 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13228 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013229 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13230 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13231 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13232 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13233 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13234
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013235rand([<range>]) : integer
13236 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13237 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13238 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13239 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13240 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013242srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13243 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13244 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13245 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13246 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13247 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13248 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13249 methods.
13250
13251srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13252 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13253 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13254 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13255 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13256 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13257 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13258 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13259
13260srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13261 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13262 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013263 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013264 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13265 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13266 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13267 overloading servers).
13268
13269 Example :
13270 # Redirect to a separate back
13271 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13272 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13273 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13274
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013275stopping : boolean
13276 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13277 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13278 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13279
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013280str(<string>) : string
13281 Returns a string.
13282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13284 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13285 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13286
13287table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13288 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13289 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13290 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13291
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013292var(<var-name>) : undefined
13293 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013294 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13295 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013296 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013297 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13298 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013299 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013300 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13301 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013302 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013303 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013304
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133057.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013306----------------------------------
13307
13308The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13309closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13310methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13311sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13312TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013313the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13314counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13315"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013316argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13317the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13318this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319
13320be_id : integer
13321 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13322 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13323
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013324be_name : string
13325 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13326 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328dst : ip
13329 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13330 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13331 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13332 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13333 RFC 4291.
13334
13335dst_conn : integer
13336 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13337 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13338 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13339 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13340 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13341 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13342 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13343 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013344
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013345dst_is_local : boolean
13346 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13347 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13348 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13349 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13350 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13351 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13352 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13353 it only once per connection.
13354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013355dst_port : integer
13356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13357 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13358 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13359 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13360 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13361 an HTTP header.
13362
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013363fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13364 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13365 header.
13366
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013367fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13368 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13369 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13370 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13371 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13372 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13373 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13374
13375fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13376 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13377 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13378 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13379 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13380 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13381 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13382
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013383fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13384 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13385 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13386 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13387 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13388
13389fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13390 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13391 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13392 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13393 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13394
13395fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13396 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13397 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13398 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13399 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13400
13401fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13402 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13403 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13404 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13405 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13406
13407fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13408 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13409 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13410 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13411 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13412
13413fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13414 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13415 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13416 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13417 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013419fe_id : integer
13420 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013421 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013422 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13423
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013424fe_name : string
13425 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13426 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13427 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13428
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013429sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013430sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13431sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13432sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013433 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13434 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13435 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13436
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013437sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013438sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13439sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13440sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013441 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13442 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13443 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13444
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013445sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013446sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13447sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13448sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013449 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13450 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013451 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13452 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13453 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013454
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013455 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013456 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13457 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013458 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13459 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13460 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013461 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13462 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13463
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013464sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013465sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13466sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13467sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013468 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13469 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013471sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013472sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13473sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13474sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013475 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13476 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13477 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13478
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013479sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013480sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13481sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13482sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013483 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13484 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13485 See also src_conn_rate.
13486
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013487sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013488sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13489sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13490sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013491 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013492 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013493
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013494sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13495sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13496sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13497sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13498 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13499 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13500
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013501sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013502sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13503sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13504sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013505 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13506 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13507 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013508 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13509 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13510 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013511
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013512sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013513sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13514sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13515sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013516 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13517 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13518 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13519
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013520sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013521sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13522sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13523sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013524 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13525 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13526 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13527 src_http_err_rate.
13528
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013529sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013530sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13531sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13532sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013533 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13534 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13535 src_http_req_cnt.
13536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013537sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013538sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13539sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13540sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013541 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13542 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13543 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13544 src_http_req_rate.
13545
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013546sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013547sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13548sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13549sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013550 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013551 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13552 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13553 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13554 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013555
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013556 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013557 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13558 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013559 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13560
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013561sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013562sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13563sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13564sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013565 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13566 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13567 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013568
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013569sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013570sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13571sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13572sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013573 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13574 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13575 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013576
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013577sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013578sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13579sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13580sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013581 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13582 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13583 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13584 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013585 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013586 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13587
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013588sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013589sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13590sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13591sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013592 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13593 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13594 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13595 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13596 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013597 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013598
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013599sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013600sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13601sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13602sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013603 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13604 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13605 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13606
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013607sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013608sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13609sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13610sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013611 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13612 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013613 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013614 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13615 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013616 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13617 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13618 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013620so_id : integer
13621 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13622 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13623 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013625src : ip
13626 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13627 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13628 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13629 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013630 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13631 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13632 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13633 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013634
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013635 Example:
13636 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13637 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013639src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13640 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13641 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13642 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013643 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13646 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13647 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013648 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013649 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013651src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13652 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13653 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13654 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13655 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13656 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13657 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013658
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013659 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013660 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13661 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13662 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13663 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013664 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013665 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13666 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013668src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013669 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013670 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013671 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013672 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013674src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013675 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013676 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13677 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013678 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13681 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13682 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13683 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013684 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013686src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013687 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013688 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013689 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013690 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013691
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013692src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13693 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13694 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13695 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13696 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013698src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013699 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013700 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013701 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13702 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013703 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13704 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13705 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013707src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13708 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13709 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013710 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013711 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013712 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13715 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13716 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13717 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13718 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013719 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13722 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13723 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13724 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013725 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013727src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13728 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13729 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13730 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013731 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013732 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13735 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13736 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13737 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013738 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013739 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13740 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013741
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013742 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013743 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013744 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013745 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013746
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013747src_is_local : boolean
13748 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13749 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13750 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13751 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13752 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13753 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13754 once per connection.
13755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013757 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13758 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13759 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13760 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13761 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013764 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13765 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13766 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13767 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13768 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013770src_port : integer
13771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13772 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13773 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13774 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13777 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013778 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13779 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13780 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013781 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013783src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13784 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13785 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13786 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13787 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013788 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13791 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13792 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13793 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13794 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13795 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13796 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13797 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13798 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013799
13800 Example :
13801 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13802 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13803 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13804 listen ssh
13805 bind :22
13806 mode tcp
13807 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013808 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013809 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013810 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013812srv_id : integer
13813 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13814 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13815 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013816
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138177.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013818----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013820The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13821closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13822when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13823usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013824future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013825
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001382651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13827 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13828 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13829 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13830 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13831 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13832
13833 Example :
13834 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13835 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13836 # the request.
13837 frontend http-in
13838 bind *:8081
13839 default_backend servers
13840 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13841 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13842
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013843ssl_bc : boolean
13844 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13845 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13846 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13847
13848ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13849 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13850 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13851
13852ssl_bc_cipher : string
13853 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13854 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13855
13856ssl_bc_protocol : string
13857 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13858 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13859
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013860ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013861 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013862 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13863 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013864
13865ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13866 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13867 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13868 if session was reused or not.
13869
13870ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13871 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13872 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13875 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13876 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13877 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13878 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13879 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013881ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13882 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13883 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13884 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13885 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013886
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013887ssl_c_der : binary
13888 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13889 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13890 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013892ssl_c_err : integer
13893 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13894 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13895 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13896 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13897 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13900 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13901 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13902 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13903 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13904 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13905 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13906 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13907 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909ssl_c_key_alg : string
13910 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13911 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13912 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013914ssl_c_notafter : string
13915 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13916 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13917 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013919ssl_c_notbefore : string
13920 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13921 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13922 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013924ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13925 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13926 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13927 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13928 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13929 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13930 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13931 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13932 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013934ssl_c_serial : binary
13935 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13936 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13937 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013939ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13940 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13941 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13942 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013943 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13944 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13945
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013946 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013947 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13950 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13951 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13952 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954ssl_c_used : boolean
13955 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13956 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013958ssl_c_verify : integer
13959 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13960 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13961 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13962 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964ssl_c_version : integer
13965 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13966 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013967
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013968ssl_f_der : binary
13969 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13970 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13971 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013973ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13974 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13975 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13976 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13977 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013978 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13980 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13981 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013983ssl_f_key_alg : string
13984 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13985 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13986 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988ssl_f_notafter : string
13989 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13990 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13991 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993ssl_f_notbefore : string
13994 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13995 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13996 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013998ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13999 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14000 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14001 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14002 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14003 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14004 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14005 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14006 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014008ssl_f_serial : binary
14009 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14010 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14011 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014012
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014013ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14014 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14015 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14016 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14019 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14020 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14021 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014023ssl_f_version : integer
14024 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14025 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14026
14027ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014028 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14029 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14030 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014032 Example :
14033 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14034 listen http-https
14035 bind :80
14036 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14037 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14038
14039ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14040 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14041 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14042
14043ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014044 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014045 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14046 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14047 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14048 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14049 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14050 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14051 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14052 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014054ssl_fc_cipher : string
14055 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14056 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014057
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014058ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14059 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14060 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014061 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014062
14063ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14064 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14065 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014066 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014067
14068ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14069 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14070 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14071 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14072 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14073 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14074 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14075
14076ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14077 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14078 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014079 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014082 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14083 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014084 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14085 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14086 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14087 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14090 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014091 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14092 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14093 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14094 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014095
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014096ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014097 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14098 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014100ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014101 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014102 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14103 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14104 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14105 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14106 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14107 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14108 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014110ssl_fc_protocol : string
14111 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14112 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014113
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014114ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014115 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014116 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14117 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14120 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14121 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14122 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14123 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014125ssl_fc_sni : string
14126 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14127 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14128 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14129 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14130 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14131
14132 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14133 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14134 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014135 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14136 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014138 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014139 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14140 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014142ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14143 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14144 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014145
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014146
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141477.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014148------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14151sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14152only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14153For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14154be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14155can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14156sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14157for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14158content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014160payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14161 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14162 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14163 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14166 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14167 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14168 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014170req.len : integer
14171req_len : integer (deprecated)
14172 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14173 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14174 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14175 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14176 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14177 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14178 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14179 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014181req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14182 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014183 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14184 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14185 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14186 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014188 ACL alternatives :
14189 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14192 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14193 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14194 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14195 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197 ACL alternatives :
14198 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014202req.proto_http : boolean
14203req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14204 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14205 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14206 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14207 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14208 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14209 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14210 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014212 Example:
14213 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14214 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14215 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014216 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14219rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14220 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14221 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14222 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14223 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14224 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14225 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14226 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14229 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14230 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14231 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14232 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14233 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014235 ACL derivatives :
14236 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238 Example :
14239 listen tse-farm
14240 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14241 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14242 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14243 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14244 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14245 persist rdp-cookie
14246 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14247 # This is only useful makes sense if
14248 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14249 stick-table type string size 204800
14250 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14251 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14252 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14255 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14258rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14259 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14260 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14261 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14262 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264 ACL derivatives :
14265 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014266
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014267req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14268 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14269 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014270 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14271 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14272 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14273 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14274 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14277req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14278 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14279 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14280 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14281 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14282 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14283 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14284 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014286req.ssl_sni : string
14287req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14288 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14289 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14290 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14291 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14292 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14293 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14294 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14295 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14296 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14297 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14298 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14299 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014301 ACL derivatives :
14302 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014304 Examples :
14305 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14306 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14307 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14308 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14309 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014310
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014311req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14312 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14313 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14314 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14315 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14316 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14317 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14318 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14319 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14320 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014322req.ssl_ver : integer
14323req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14324 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14325 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14326 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14327 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14328 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14329 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14330 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14331 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14332 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334 ACL derivatives :
14335 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014336
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014337res.len : integer
14338 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14339 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14340 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14341 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14342 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14343 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14344 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14345 content inspection.
14346
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014347res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14348 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014349 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14350 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14351 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14352 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014354res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14355 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14356 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14357 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14358 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014361
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014362res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14363rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14364 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14365 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14366 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14367 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14368 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14369 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14370 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014372wait_end : boolean
14373 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14374 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14375 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14376 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14377 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14378 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14379 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14380 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014382 Examples :
14383 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14384 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14385 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14388 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14389 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14390 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14391 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14392 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14393 tcp-request content reject
14394
14395
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143967.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397--------------------------------------
14398
14399It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14400This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14401data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14402its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14403HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14404content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14405to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14406more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14407response are indexed.
14408
14409base : string
14410 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14411 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14412 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14413 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14414 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14415 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14416 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14417 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14418
14419 ACL derivatives :
14420 base : exact string match
14421 base_beg : prefix match
14422 base_dir : subdir match
14423 base_dom : domain match
14424 base_end : suffix match
14425 base_len : length match
14426 base_reg : regex match
14427 base_sub : substring match
14428
14429base32 : integer
14430 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14431 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14432 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014433 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14434 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14435 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436
14437base32+src : binary
14438 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14439 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14440 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14441 per-URL counters.
14442
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014443capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14444 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14445 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14446 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14447
14448capture.req.method : string
14449 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14450 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14451 because it's allocated.
14452
14453capture.req.uri : string
14454 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14455 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14456 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14457 allocated.
14458
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014459capture.req.ver : string
14460 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14461 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14462 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14463
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014464capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14465 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14466 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14467 The first entry is an index of 0.
14468 See also: "capture response header"
14469
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014470capture.res.ver : string
14471 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14472 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14473 persistent flag.
14474
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014475req.body : binary
14476 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14477 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14478 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14479 the first chunk is analyzed.
14480
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014481req.body_param([<name>) : string
14482 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14483 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14484 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14485 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14486 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14487 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14488 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14489 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14490 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14491 given.
14492
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014493req.body_len : integer
14494 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14495 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14496 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14497 "option http-buffer-request".
14498
14499req.body_size : integer
14500 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14501 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14502 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14503 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14504 "option http-buffer-request".
14505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014506req.cook([<name>]) : string
14507cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14508 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14509 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14510 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14511 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14512 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14513 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14514 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14515 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14516
14517 ACL derivatives :
14518 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14519 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14520 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14521 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14522 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14523 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14524 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14525 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14528cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14529 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14530 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014532req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14533cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14534 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14535 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14536 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14537 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14540 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14541 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14542 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14543 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014544 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14546 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14547 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14548 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14551 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14552 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14553 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14554 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014555 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14558 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14559 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14560 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14561 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14562 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14563 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14564 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14565 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14568 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14569 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14570 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14571 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14574 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14575 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14576 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14577 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14578 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14579 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14580 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14581 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14582 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14583 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14584 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014586 ACL derivatives :
14587 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14588 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14589 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14590 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14591 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14592 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14593 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14594 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14595
14596req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14597hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14598 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14599 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14600 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14601 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14602 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14603 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14604 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14605 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14606 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14607
14608req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14609hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14610 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14611 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14612 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14613 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14614 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14615 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14616 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14617 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14618
14619req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14620hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14621 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14622 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14623 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14624 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14625 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14626 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14627 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14628
14629http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14630 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14631 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14632 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14633 basic auth is supported.
14634
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014635http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14636 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14637 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14638 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14639 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014640 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14641 basic auth is supported.
14642
14643 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014644 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14645 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14646 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14647 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014648
14649http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014650 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14651 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14653 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014655method : integer + string
14656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14657 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14658 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14659 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14660 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14661 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14662 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014664 ACL derivatives :
14665 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014667 Example :
14668 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14669 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14670 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014672path : string
14673 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14674 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14675 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14676 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14677 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14678 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14679 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014681 ACL derivatives :
14682 path : exact string match
14683 path_beg : prefix match
14684 path_dir : subdir match
14685 path_dom : domain match
14686 path_end : suffix match
14687 path_len : length match
14688 path_reg : regex match
14689 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014690
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014691query : string
14692 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14693 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14694 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14695 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014696 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014697 which stops before the question mark.
14698
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014699req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14700 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14701 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14702 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14703 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014705req.ver : string
14706req_ver : string (deprecated)
14707 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14708 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14709 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014711 ACL derivatives :
14712 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714res.comp : boolean
14715 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14716 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14717 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719res.comp_algo : string
14720 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14721 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14722 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014724res.cook([<name>]) : string
14725scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14726 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14727 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14728 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014730 ACL derivatives :
14731 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014733res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14734scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14735 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14736 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14737 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014738
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014739res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14740scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14741 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14742 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14743 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014745res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14746 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14747 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14748 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14749 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14750 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14751 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14752 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14753 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14754 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014756res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14757 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14758 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14759 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14760 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14761 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014763res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14764shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14765 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14766 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14767 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14768 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14769 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14770 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14771 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14772 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014774 ACL derivatives :
14775 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14776 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14777 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14778 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14779 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14780 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14781 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14782 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14783
14784res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14785shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14786 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14787 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14788 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14789 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14790 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014792res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14793shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14794 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14795 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14796 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14797 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14798 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14799 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014800
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014801res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14802 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14803 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14804 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14805 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14808shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14809 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14810 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14811 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14812 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14813 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14814 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014816res.ver : string
14817resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14818 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14819 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014821 ACL derivatives :
14822 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14825 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14826 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014827 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014828 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14831 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833status : integer
14834 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14835 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14836 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014837
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014838unique-id : string
14839 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14840 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14841 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14842 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14843 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14844 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014846url : string
14847 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14848 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14849 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14850 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14851 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14852 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14853 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014855 ACL derivatives :
14856 url : exact string match
14857 url_beg : prefix match
14858 url_dir : subdir match
14859 url_dom : domain match
14860 url_end : suffix match
14861 url_len : length match
14862 url_reg : regex match
14863 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014865url_ip : ip
14866 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14867 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14868 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14869 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14870 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14871 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14872 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014874url_port : integer
14875 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14876 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14877 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14878 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014879
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014880urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14881url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14883 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014884 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14885 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14886 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14887 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14889 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014890 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14891 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893 ACL derivatives :
14894 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14895 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14896 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14897 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14898 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14899 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14900 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14901 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014902
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904 Example :
14905 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14906 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14907 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14908 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014909
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014910urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14912 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14913 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014914
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014915url32 : integer
14916 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14917 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14918 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14919 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14920 is an unsigned integer.
14921
14922url32+src : binary
14923 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14924 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14925 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14926
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149287.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014929---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014931Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14932every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014933order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014935ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14936---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014937FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014938HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014939HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14940HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014941HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14942HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14943HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14944HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14945LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014946METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014947METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014948METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14949METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14950METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14951METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014952METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014953METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014954RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014955REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014956TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014957WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14958---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014959
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149618. Logging
14962----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014963
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014964One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14965provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14966very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14967provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14968state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014969to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014970headers.
14971
14972In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14973about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14974send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14975
14976 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14977 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14978 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14979 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14980 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014981 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14982 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014983
14984The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14985allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14986as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14987while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14988real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14989delay.
14990
14991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149928.1. Log levels
14993---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014994
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014995TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014996source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014997HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14998in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14999track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15000syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15001about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015002
15003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150048.2. Log formats
15005----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015006
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015007HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015008and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15009slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15010options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015011
15012 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15013 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15014 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15015 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15016 extents.
15017
15018 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15019 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15020 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15021 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15022 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15023
15024 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15025 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15026 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15027 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15028 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15029
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015030 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15031 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15032 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15033 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15034
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015035 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15036
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015037Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15038specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15039field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15040servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15041always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15042identifier.
15043
15044Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15045 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15046 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15047 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15048 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15049
15050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150518.2.1. Default log format
15052-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015053
15054This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15055as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15056format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15057
15058 Example :
15059 listen www
15060 mode http
15061 log global
15062 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15063
15064 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15065 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15066 (www/HTTP)
15067
15068 Field Format Extract from the example above
15069 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15070 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15071 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15072 4 'to' to
15073 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15074 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15075
15076Detailed fields description :
15077 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15078 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15079 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15080 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15081 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15082 and processed the connection.
15083 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15084
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015085In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15086"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15087connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15088
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015089It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15090will eventually disappear.
15091
15092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150938.2.2. TCP log format
15094---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015095
15096The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15097is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15098information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15099counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15100emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15101environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15102the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15103sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015104specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15105not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15106fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15107marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015108
15109 Example :
15110 frontend fnt
15111 mode tcp
15112 option tcplog
15113 log global
15114 default_backend bck
15115
15116 backend bck
15117 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15118
15119 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15120 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15121 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15122
15123 Field Format Extract from the example above
15124 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15125 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15126 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15127 4 frontend_name fnt
15128 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15129 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15130 7 bytes_read* 212
15131 8 termination_state --
15132 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15133 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15134
15135Detailed fields description :
15136 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015137 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15138 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15139 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015140 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15141 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15142 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015143
15144 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015145 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15146 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15147 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015148
15149 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15150 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15151 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15152 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15153
15154 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15155 and processed the connection.
15156
15157 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15158 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15159 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15160 applications.
15161
15162 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15163 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15164 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15165 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15166 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15167
15168 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15169 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15170 See "Timers" below for more details.
15171
15172 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15173 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15174 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15175 "Timers" below for more details.
15176
15177 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015178 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015179 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15180 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15181 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15182 details.
15183
15184 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15185 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15186 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15187 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15188 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15189
15190 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15191 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15192 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15193 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15194 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15195 for more details.
15196
15197 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015198 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015199 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15200 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15201 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015202 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015203
15204 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15205 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15206 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15207 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15208 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15209 caused by a denial of service attack.
15210
15211 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15212 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15213 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15214 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15215 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15216 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15217 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15218 denial of service attack.
15219
15220 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15221 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15222 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15223 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15224 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15225 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15226 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15227 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15228 be processed than on other servers.
15229
15230 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15231 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15232 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15233 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15234 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15235 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15236 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15237 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15238 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15239 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15240 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15241 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15242 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15243
15244 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15245 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15246 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15247 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15248 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15249 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15250 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15251 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15252
15253 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15254 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15255 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15256 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15257 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15258 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15259 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15260 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15261 occurs.
15262
15263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152648.2.3. HTTP log format
15265----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015266
15267The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15268is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15269the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15270are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15271emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15272generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15273"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15274which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015275frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15276is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015277
15278Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15279slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15280with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15281
15282 Example :
15283 frontend http-in
15284 mode http
15285 option httplog
15286 log global
15287 default_backend bck
15288
15289 backend static
15290 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15291
15292 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15293 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15294 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015295 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015296
15297 Field Format Extract from the example above
15298 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15299 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015300 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015301 4 frontend_name http-in
15302 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015303 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015304 7 status_code 200
15305 8 bytes_read* 2750
15306 9 captured_request_cookie -
15307 10 captured_response_cookie -
15308 11 termination_state ----
15309 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15310 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15311 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15312 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15313 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015314
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015315Detailed fields description :
15316 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015317 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15318 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15319 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015320 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15321 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15322 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015323
15324 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015325 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15326 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15327 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015328
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015329 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15330 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015331
15332 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15333 and processed the connection.
15334
15335 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15336 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15337 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15338
15339 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15340 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15341 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15342 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15343 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15344 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15345
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015346 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15347 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15348 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15349 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15350 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15351 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15352 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015353
15354 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15355 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15356 See "Timers" below for more details.
15357
15358 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15359 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15360 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15361 below for more details.
15362
15363 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15364 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15365 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15366 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15367 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15368 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15369 for more details.
15370
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015371 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15372 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15373 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15374 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15375 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15376 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15377 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15378 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015379
15380 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15381 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15382 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15383
15384 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15385 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15386 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15387 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15388 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15389 overflowing.
15390
15391 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15392 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15393 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15394 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15395 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15396 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15397 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15398 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15399
15400 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15401 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15402 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15403 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15404 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15405 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15406 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15407 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15408
15409 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15410 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15411 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15412 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15413 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15414 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15415 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15416
15417 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015418 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015419 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15420 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15421 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015422 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015423 system.
15424
15425 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15426 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15427 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15428 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15429 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15430 caused by a denial of service attack.
15431
15432 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15433 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15434 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15435 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15436 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15437 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15438 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15439 denial of service attack.
15440
15441 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15442 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15443 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15444 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15445 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15446 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15447 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15448 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15449 processed than on other servers.
15450
15451 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15452 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15453 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15454 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15455 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15456 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15457 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15458 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15459 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15460 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15461 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15462 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15463 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15464
15465 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15466 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15467 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15468 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15469 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15470 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15471 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15472 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15473
15474 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15475 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15476 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15477 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15478 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15479 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15480 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15481 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15482 occurs.
15483
15484 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15485 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15486 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15487 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15488 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15489 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15490 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15491 cookies" below for more details.
15492
15493 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15494 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15495 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15496 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15497 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15498 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15499 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15500 and cookies" below for more details.
15501
15502 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15503 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15504 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15505 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15506 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15507 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15508 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15509 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15510
15511
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200155128.2.4. Custom log format
15513------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015514
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015515The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015516mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015517
15518HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15519Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15520separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15521prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15522
15523Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15524variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015525("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015526
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015527If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015528as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015529less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15530the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15531
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015532Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015533In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015534in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015535
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015536Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15537'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15538https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15539such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15540
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015541Flags are :
15542 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015543 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015544 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15545 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015546
15547 Example:
15548
15549 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15550 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15551
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015552 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15553
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015554At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15555
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015556 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15557 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015558
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015559the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015560
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015561 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15562 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15563 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015564
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015565and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15566
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015567 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15568 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015569
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015570Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15571
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015572 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015573 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015574 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15575 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15576 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015577 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15578 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15579 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015580 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015581 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15582 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015583 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015584 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15585 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015586 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015587 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015588 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015589 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015590 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015591 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015592 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015593 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15594 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15595 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15596 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15597 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015598 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015599 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15600 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015601 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015602 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15603 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015604 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15605 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15606 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015607 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015608 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15609 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015610 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015611 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15612 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15613 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015614 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015615 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015616 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15617 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15618 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15619 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015620 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015621 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015622 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015623 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015624 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015625 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015626 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15627 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15628 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015629 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015630 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15631 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015632 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015633 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15634 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15635 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015636 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015637 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015638 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015639
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015640 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015641
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015642
156438.2.5. Error log format
15644-----------------------
15645
15646When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15647protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15648By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15649"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15650will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15651logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15652
15653The format looks like this :
15654
15655 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15656 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15657 Connection error during SSL handshake
15658
15659 Field Format Extract from the example above
15660 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15661 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15662 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15663 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15664 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15665
15666These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15667failures.
15668
15669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156708.3. Advanced logging options
15671-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015672
15673Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15674just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15675options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15676for more information about their usage.
15677
15678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15680------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015681
15682It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15683haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15684commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15685monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15686ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15687
15688 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15689 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15690 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15691 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15692
15693 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15694 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15695 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015696 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015697 such as other load-balancers.
15698
15699 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15700 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15701 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15702
15703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15705----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015706
15707The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15708what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15709or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15710"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15711just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15712log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15713after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15714is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15715with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15716with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15717
15718
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157198.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15720------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015721
15722Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15723for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15724"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15725retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15726raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15727a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15728file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15729you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15730"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15731
15732
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157338.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15734--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015735
15736Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15737multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15738them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15739"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15740logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15741error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15742and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15743too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15744useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15745alternative.
15746
15747
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157488.4. Timing events
15749------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015750
15751Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15752reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15753the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15754frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015755mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15756addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15757
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015758Timings events in HTTP mode:
15759
15760 first request 2nd request
15761 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15762 t tr t tr ...
15763 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15764 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15765 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15766 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15767 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15768
15769Timings events in TCP mode:
15770
15771 TCP session
15772 |<----------------->|
15773 t t
15774 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15775 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15776 |<------ Tt ------->|
15777
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015778 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15779 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15780 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15781 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15782 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15783 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15784 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015785
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015786 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15787 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15788 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15789 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15790 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15791 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15792 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15793 nothing was received on the connection.
15794
15795 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15796 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15797 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15798 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15799 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15800 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15801 request typed by hand during a test.
15802
15803 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15804 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15805 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15806 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15807 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15808 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15809 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015810
15811 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15812 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15813 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15814 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15815 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15816
15817 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15818 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15819 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15820 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15821 connection never established.
15822
15823 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15824 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15825 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15826 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15827 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15828 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15829 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15830 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15831 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15832 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15833 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15834
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015835 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15836 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15837 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15838 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15839 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15840 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15841
15842 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15843
15844 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15845 "Ta" can never be negative.
15846
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015847 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15848 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015849 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15850 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015851 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015853 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015854
15855 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015856 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15857 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015858
15859These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15860protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15861that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015862due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15863"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15864that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015865
15866Most common cases :
15867
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015868 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15869 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15870 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15871 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15872 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15873 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15874 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15875 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15876 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15877 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15878 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015879 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015880
15881 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15882 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15883 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15884 of ms on remote networks.
15885
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015886 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15887 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15888 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015889
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015890 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15891 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15892 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15893 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15894 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15895 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15896 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15897 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15898 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015899
15900Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15901
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015902 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015903 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015904 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015905
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015906 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015907 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15908 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15909
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015910 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015911 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15912 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15913 flags.
15914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015915 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15916 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015917 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15918 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15919 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15920 the client connection was maintained open.
15921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015922 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015923 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015924 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015925 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15926
15927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159288.5. Session state at disconnection
15929-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015930
15931TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15932"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
159332-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15934each of which has a special meaning :
15935
15936 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15937 session to terminate :
15938
15939 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15940
15941 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15942 server explicitly refused it.
15943
15944 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15945 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15946 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15947 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015948 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15949
15950 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15951 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015952
15953 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15954 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15955 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15956 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15957 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15958
15959 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15960 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15961 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15962 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15963 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15964
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015965 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15966 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15967
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015968 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15969 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15970 backup connections when going up.
15971
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015972 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15973
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015974 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15975 send or receive data.
15976
15977 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15978 send or receive data.
15979
15980 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15981 with nothing left in the buffers.
15982
15983 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15984
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015985 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015986 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15987
15988 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15989 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15990 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15991 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15992 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15993
15994 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15995 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15996
15997 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15998 server (HTTP only).
15999
16000 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16001
16002 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16003 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16004 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16005
16006 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16007 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16008 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16009
16010 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16011
16012 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16013 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16014
16015 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16016 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16017 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16018
16019 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16020 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016021 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16022 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016023
16024 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16025 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16026 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16027 another server.
16028
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016029 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016030 server.
16031
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016032 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16033 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16034 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16035 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16036
16037 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16038 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16039 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16040 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16041
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016042 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16043 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16044 "use-server" rule).
16045
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016046 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16047
16048 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16049 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16050
16051 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16052
16053 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16054 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16055 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16056
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016057 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16058 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016059 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016060 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16061 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016063 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16064
16065 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16066 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16067
16068 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16069
16070 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16071
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016072The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16073was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016074helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16075starvation, attacks, etc...
16076
16077The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16078alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16079easier finding and understanding.
16080
16081 Flags Reason
16082
16083 -- Normal termination.
16084
16085 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16086 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16087 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16088 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16089
16090 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16091 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16092 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16093 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16094 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16095 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16098 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016099 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016100
16101 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16102 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16103 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16104
16105 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16106 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16107 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16108 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16109 the server takes too long to respond.
16110
16111 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16112 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16113 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16114 long a time to respond.
16115
16116 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16117 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16118 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16119 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016120 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16121 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016122
16123 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16124 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16125 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16126 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16127 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016128 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016129 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16130 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16131 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16132 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16133 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16134 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16135 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16136 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16137 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16138 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16139 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16140 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016141
16142 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16143 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016144 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16145 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16146 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16147 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016149 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16150 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16151
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016152 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016153 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16154 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16155 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16156 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16157 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16158
16159 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16160 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16161 503 or 504 here.
16162
16163 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16164 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16165 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16166 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16167 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16168
16169 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16170 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016171 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016172 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16173 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16174
16175 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16176 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16177 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16178 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16179 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16180 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16181 between haproxy and the server.
16182
16183 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16184 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16185 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16186 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16187 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16188 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16189 solution is to fix the application.
16190
16191 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16192 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16193 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16194 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16195 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16196 external attacks.
16197
16198 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16199 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016200 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016201 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16202 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16203
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016204 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16205 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16206 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016207 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16208 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016209
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016210 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16211 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16212 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16213 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016214 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16215 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16216 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16217 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16218 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016219
16220 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16221 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16222 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16223 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16224
16225 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16226 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16227 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16228 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16229
16230 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16231 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16232 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16233 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16234
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016235The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16236persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16237important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16238re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16239
16240 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16241
16242 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16243 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16244 set on a GET request.
16245
16246 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16247 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016248 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016249 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16250
16251 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16252 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16253 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16254
16255 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16256 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16257 already got a cookie.
16258
16259 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16260 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16261 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16262 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16263 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16264
16265 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16266 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16267 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16268
16269 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16270 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16271 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16272
16273 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16274 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16275
16276 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16277 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16278 then advertised in the response.
16279
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162818.6. Non-printable characters
16282-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016283
16284In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16285consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16286converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16287prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16288being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16289escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16290is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16291'}' when logging headers.
16292
16293Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16294issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16295containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16296
16297Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16298the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16299performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16300
16301
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16303---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016304
16305Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16306achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016307section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016308cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16309the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16310the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016311locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016312not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16313user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16314a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16315wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16316
16317 Examples :
16318 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16319 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16320
16321 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16322 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16323
16324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163258.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16326---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016327
16328Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16329proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16330the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16331server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16332
16333Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16334response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016335section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016336
16337It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016338time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16339appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016340are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16341and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16342follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16343request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16344in the logs.
16345
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016346As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16347frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16348an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16349
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016350 Example :
16351 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16352 listen proxy-out
16353 mode http
16354 option httplog
16355 option logasap
16356 log global
16357 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16358
16359 # log the name of the virtual server
16360 capture request header Host len 20
16361
16362 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16363 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16364
16365 # log the beginning of the referrer
16366 capture request header Referer len 20
16367
16368 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16369 capture response header Server len 20
16370
16371 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16372 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16373
16374 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16375 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16376
16377 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16378 capture response header Via len 20
16379
16380 # log the URL location during a redirection
16381 capture response header Location len 20
16382
16383 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16384 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16385 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16386 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16387 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16388
16389 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16390 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16391 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16392 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016393 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016394
16395 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16396 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16397 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16398 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16399 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016400 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016401
16402
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164038.9. Examples of logs
16404---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016405
16406These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16407them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16408reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16409
16410 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16411 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16412 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16413
16414 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16415 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16416
16417 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16418 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16419 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16420
16421 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16422 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16423
16424 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16425 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16426 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16427
16428 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016429 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016430 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16431 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16432
16433 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16434 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16435 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16436
16437 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16438 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016439 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016440 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16441 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16442 to return the 502 and not the server.
16443
16444 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016445 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016446
16447 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16448 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16449 Nothing was sent to any server.
16450
16451 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16452 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16453
16454 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16455 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16456 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16457 send a 408 return code to the client.
16458
16459 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16460 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16461
16462 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16463 5 seconds ("c----").
16464
16465 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16466 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016467 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468
16469 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016470 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016471 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16472 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16473 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16474 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16475 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016476
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016477
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200164789. Supported filters
16479--------------------
16480
16481Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16482accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16483unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16484
16485See also : "filter"
16486
164879.1. Trace
16488----------
16489
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016490filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016491
16492 Arguments:
16493 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16494 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16495
16496 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16497 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16498 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16499 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16500
16501 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16502 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16503 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16504 amount of the parsed data.
16505
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016506 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16507
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016508This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16509callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16510information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16511filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16512
16513Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16514tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16515a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16516
16517
165189.2. HTTP compression
16519---------------------
16520
16521filter compression
16522
16523The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16524keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16525when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16526use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16527used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16528filters evaluation order.
16529
16530See also : "compression"
16531
16532
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200165339.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16534--------------------------------------------
16535
16536filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16537
16538 Arguments :
16539
16540 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16541 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16542 parsed.
16543
16544 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16545 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16546 part must be placed in its own scope.
16547
16548The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16549external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16550streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16551exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16552also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16553
16554SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16555the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16556
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016557For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016558"doc/SPOE.txt".
16559
16560Important note:
16561 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16562 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16563
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016564/*
16565 * Local variables:
16566 * fill-column: 79
16567 * End:
16568 */